Japan Radio Co JSS-2500 Marine MF/HF GMDSS Radio Transceiver, digital selective calling (DSC) / narrow-band direct printing (NBDP) Modem User Manual
Japan Radio Co Ltd. Marine MF/HF GMDSS Radio Transceiver, digital selective calling (DSC) / narrow-band direct printing (NBDP) Modem
User Manual
MF/HF RADIO EQUIPMENT Instruction Manual 7ZPJD0622 . CAUTIONS AGAINST HIGH VOLTAGE Radio and radar devices are operated by high voltages of anywhere from a few hundred volts up to many hundreds of thousands of volts. Although there is no danger with normal use, it is very dangerous if contact is made with the internal parts of these devices. (Only specialists should attempt any maintenance, checking or adjusting.) There is a very high risk of death by even a few thousand volts, in some cases you can be fatally electrocuted by just a few hundred volts. To prevent accidents, you should avoid contact with the internal parts of these devices at all costs. If contact is inevitable as in the case of an emergency, you must switch off the devices and ground a terminal in order to discharge the capacitors. After making certain that all the electricity is discharged, only then can you insert your hand into the device. Wearing cotton gloves and putting your left hand in your pocket, in order not to use both hands simultaneously, are also very good methods of shock prevention. Quite often, an injury occurs by secondary factors, therefore it is necessary to choose a sturdy and level working surface. If someone is electrocuted it is necessary to thoroughly disinfect the affected area and seek medical attention as soon as possible. Cautions concerning treatment of electrocution victims When you find an electrocution victim, you must first switch off the machinery and ground all circuits. If you are unable to cut off the machinery, move the victim away from it using a non-conductive material such as dry boards or clothing. When someone is electrocuted, and the electrical current reaches the breathing synapses of the central nervous system inside the brain, breathing stops. If the victim's condition is stable, he or she can be administered artificial respiration. An electrocution victim becomes very pale, and their pulse can be very weak or even stop, consequently losing consciousness and becoming stiff. Administration of first aid is critical in this situation. First aid ☆Note points for first aid Unless there is impending danger leave the victim where he or she is, then begin artificial respiration. Once you begin artificial respiration, you must continue without losing rhythm. (1) Make contact with the victim cautiously, there is a risk that you may get electrocuted. (2) Switch off the machinery and then move the victim away slowly if you must. (3) Inform someone immediately (a hospital or doctor, dial emergency numbers, etc.). (4) Lay the victim on his or her back and loosen any constrictive clothing (a tie, or belt). (5) (a) Check the victim's pulse. (b) Check for a heartbeat by pressing your ear against the victim's chest. (c) Check if the victim is breathing by putting the back of your hand or face near the victim's face. (d) Check the pupils of the eyes. (6) Open the victim's mouth and remove any artificial teeth, cigarette or chewing gum. Leave the mouth opened and flatten the tongue with a towel or by putting something into the mouth to prevent the victim's tongue from obstructing the throat. (If he or she is clenching the teeth and it is difficult to open the mouth, use a spoon or the like to pry open the mouth.) (7) Continually wipe the mouth to prevent the accumulation of saliva. ☆If the victim has a pulse but is not breathing (“Mouth to mouth” resuscitation) Figure 1 (1) Place the victim’s head facing backward (place something under the neck like a pillow). (2) Point the chin upward to widen the trachea. (3) Pinch the victim’s nose, take a deep breath, then put your mouth over the victim’s mouth and exhale completely, making sure that your mouth completely covers the victim’s mouth. Then remove your mouth. Repeat this routine 10 to 15 times per minute (holding the nostrils). (4) Pay attention to the victim to notice if he or she starts to breath. If breathing returns, stop resuscitation. (5) If it is impossible to open the victim’s mouth, put something like a plastic straw or vinyl tube into one of the nostrils then blow air in while covering the mouth and the other nostril. (6) Occasionally, when the victim comes back to consciousness, they immediately try to stand up. Prevent this and keep them in a laying position. Give them something warm to drink and be sure that they rest (do not give them any alcohol). Administering artificial respiration by raising the head. ① (1) Raise the back of head, then place one hand on the forehead and place the other hand under the neck. →① Most victims open their mouth when this is done, making “mouth to mouth” resuscitation easier. ② (2) Cover the victim’s mouth by opening your mouth widely, then push your cheek against the victim’s nose, →② or pinch the victim’s nose to prevent air from leaking out of it. →③ ③ (3) Completely exhale into the lungs. Exhale into the lungs until the chest inflates. You have to blow as rapidly as possible for the first 10 times. “Mouse to mouse” artificial respiration Figure 1 ☆If the victim has no pulse and is not breathing (Heart massage in combination with artificial respiration.) Figure 2 If the victim has no pulse, his or her pupils are dilated, and if you cannot detect a heartbeat, the heart may have stopped, beginning artificial respiration is critical. (1) Put both hands on the diaphragm, with hands on top of each other keeping both arms straight (If your elbows are bent, you cannot push with as much power). Press the diaphragm with your body weight until the chest sinks about 2 cm (about 50 times per minute). (2) If administering first aid when alone: Perform the heart massage about 15 times then blow in twice. Repeat this routine. If administering first aid with two people: One person performs the heart massage 5 times, and the other person blows air in once. Repeat this routine (Heart massage and “mouth to mouth” resuscitation used together). (3) Constantly check the pupils and the pulse, if the pupils become normal and the pulse steadies, keep them in a laying position and give them something warm to drink, be sure that they rest (do not give them any alcohol). In any case you have to entrust major decision making to a doctor. Having understanding people around is essential to the victim’s recovery from the mental shock of electrocution. ① ② ③ ④ (Heart massage in combination with artificial respiration.) Figure 2 Preface Thank you for choosing the Model JRC JSS-2250/2500 (JSS-2250N/2500N) MF/HF radio equipment. The radio equipment can be used as a Global Maritime Distress and Safety System (GMDSS) radio device, compliant with international regulations, that provides emergency communications and standard communications capabilities for small and large ships. ● ● Please read this instruction manual thoroughly before using the MF/HF radio equipment, and use it in accordance with the instructions contained herein. Please keep this manual available for future reference. Please refer to it if any difficulties are encountered when using the equipment. Before operation Concerning the symbols This manual uses the following symbols to explain correct operation and to prevent injury or damage to property. The symbols and descriptions are as follows. Understand them before proceeding with this manual. WARNING Indicates a warning that, if ignored, may result in serious injury or even death. CAUTION Indicates a caution that, if ignored, may result in injury or damage to property. Examples of symbols The Δ symbol indicates caution (including DANGER and WARNING). The illustration inside the Δ symbol specifies the content of the caution more accurately. (This example warns of possible electrical shock.) The ; symbol indicates that performing an action is prohibited. The illustration inside the ; symbol specifies the contents of the prohibited operation. (In this example disassembly is prohibited.) The z symbol indicates operations that must be performed. The illustration inside the z symbol specifies obligatory instructions. (In this example unplugging is the obligatory instruction.) Concerning the WARNING labels The WARNING labels are put on the NTD-2250/2500 Transceiver, NBD-2250/2500 Power supply, NFC-2250/2500 Antenna tuner, and NBB-714/724 Battery charger. Do not take off, destroy, or modify the labels. NTD-2250/2500 Transceiver (Upper view) vi NBD-2250/2500 Power supply (Upper view) NFC-2250/2500 Antenna tuner NBB-714/724 Battery charger vii Handling precautions WARNING Do not open the equipment to inspect or repair internal circuits. Inspection or repairs by anyone other than a specialized technician may result in fire, electrical shock, or malfunction. If internal inspection or repair is necessary, contact our service center or agents. Do not disassemble or customize this unit. Doing so may cause fire, electrical shock, or malfunction. Do not get this equipment wet or spill any liquids on or near this equipment. Doing so may cause electrical shock, or equipment malfunction. Do not touch any of the areas with warning labels. Doing so may cause electrical shock. Do not use voltage other than that specified. Doing so may cause fire, electrical shock, or malfunction. Do not remove protective covers on the high voltage terminals. Doing so may cause electrical shock. Do not insert anything flammable into the equipment. Doing so may cause fire, electrical shock, or malfunction. If a distress alert is received, make sure to inform the ship's captain or officer in charge. Doing so may save the lives of the crews and passengers on the ship in distress. This equipment is used for both distress communication and routine communication. Contact JRC or our agent if any problem is observed in this unit during routine operation or inspection. viii CAUTION Do not use this equipment anyplace other than specified. Doing so may cause failure or malfunction. Do not turn the trimmer resistors or the trimmer capacitors on the PCB unit. Doing so may cause failure or malfunction. Do not install the equipment in a place near water or in one with excessive humidity, steam, dust, or soot. Doing so may cause fire, electrical shock, or malfunction. Do not test the distress alert. Doing so may inconvenience local shipping and rescue centers. Do not turn off the equipment when at sea because the SOLAS Convention requires keeping watch on distress and safety frequencies at all times. Always listen to 2187.5 kHz, and 8414.5 kHz, and one or more of the following frequencies; 4207.5 kHz, 6312.0 kHz, 12577.0 kHz, or 16804.5 kHz. In class B mode, it is necessary to keep watch only on 2187.5 kHz. When completely turning off the power to the equipment, turn off the breakers on the power supply. To operate DSC functions of the equipment, the ID numbers assigned to the ship must be registered in advance. If registration is necessary, contact our service center or agents. To install this equipment, contact our service center or agents. Special knowledge on selecting the place where the antenna is to be mounted and setting the ID number (MMSI) assigned to the ship is required in addition to installing the equipment. When sending a distress alert, follow the instructions of the ship's captain or officer in charge. If a false distress alert is transmitted accidentally, select the Cancel menu and transmit the distress cancel referring the guidance displayed on the controller. And then report the false distress alert to a nearby RCC (Rescue Coordination Center/ in Japan, inform the nearest Japan Coast Guard.) Information to be reported: Ship's name, type, nationality, and ID number, the date/time, location and reason why the false distress alert was transmitted. Also the unit model name and manufacture number/date, if possible. To turn off an alarm or clear a display such as a received DSC message, do not press the DISTRESS key. Doing so may cause a false distress alert. (Press the CANCEL key to turn off the alarm.) When sending a drobose call, do NOT press the DISTRESS key. Doing so may cause a false distress alert. (Drobose calls can be sent via the [Call] button displayed on the screen.) A distress acknowledgement or a distress relay call can be transmitted using the option on an active procedure screen, but when sending such a call, follow the instructions of the ship's captain or officer in charge. ix CAUTION DSC messages with incorrect format or data may not be received, but it is not a malfunction. Also if the data terminal is not connected, the equipment does not receive DSC calls requesting ARQ/FEC communication, regardless of either the category of routine, safety, urgency or distress. Received distress message logs are automatically deleted after 48 hours to avoid accidental resending or other misoperation. Accordingly, if such messages cannot be read, it is not a malfunction. The received distress message logs are cleared when turning off the power by such as the breaker on the power supply. Due to the SOLAS Convention (keeping watch on distress and safety frequencies at all times), do not turn off the equipment when at sea. The time in the 7.1 Date & time menu means the present time, and is different from the time in the 7.2 POS/TIME menu that means the time when the position information is valid. The time in the 7.2 POS/TIME menu means the time when the position information is valid, and is different from the present time mentioned in the 7.1 Date & time menu. When replacing fuses, always use fuses of the same type. The batteries, except for sealed lead-acid batteries that require no equalization, should be carried out the equalizing charge at least every six months The thermal head of the NKG-91 printer may be very hot after printing. Do not touch the thermal head of the printer. Make sure the thermal head is cool before replacing the paper or cleaning the thermal head. The paper used in the NKG-91 printer is heat sensitive. Take the following precautions when using this paper. ・ Store the paper away from heat, humidity, or heat sources. ・ Do not rub the paper with any hard objects. ・ Do not place the paper near organic solvents. ・ Do not allow the paper to come in contact with polyvinyl chloride film, erasers, or adhesive tape for long periods of time. ・ Keep the paper away from freshly copied diazo type or wet process copy paper. The print head of the NKG-800 printer may be very hot after printing. Do not touch the print head of the printer. Make sure the print head is cool before replacing the paper or cleaning the print head. Do not use the NKG-800 printer if there is no ink ribbon cartridge or paper. Do not twist the ink ribbon when installing the ink ribbon cartridge. Before opening and closing the cover of the NKG-800 printer, turn off the printer. Wait more than 2 seconds after turning the printer off before turning it back on again so it can initialize correctly. Be sure to unmount the USB flash memory before removing it from the NDZ-227 Data terminal at work. DISTRESS ALERTS Sending a Distress Alert CAUTION When sending a distress alert, follow the instructions of the ship's captain or officer in charge. 11.. Open the DISTRESS key cover on the NCM-2150 MF/HF CONTROLLER. 22.. Press and hold the DISTRESS key for 4 seconds to send the distress alert. When the countdown is finished the screen below on the right is displayed, and after antenna tuning the distress alerts are transmitted. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL ITU- 401 RX 4357.0 kHz TX 4065.0 kHz Distress call starts SIG in sec NonDST: WKR scan bands: D R OB O S : 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz E d tD S T : ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) DSC Rx: 2187.5/Tx: 2187.5kHz Distress calling Next :--Stage :Waiting for CH free Call-F: / / / / / Nature:Undesignated PosUTC: 89゚59.0123'N :179゚59.6789'E @23:59 Mode :Radiotelephone [Cancel] SIG WKR 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz 33.. After sending the distress alert, wait for an acknowledgement. The radiotelephone can be used to communicate even while waiting for an acknowledgement on the screen below left. When an acknowledgement is received, press the CANCEL key or ENT to cancel the alarm on the below right screen, and communicate with the station. Unless an acknowledgement is received or the distress alert is cancelled manually, the equipment repeats the distress alert every 3.5 to 4.5 minutes. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) TEL Rx: 8291.0/Tx: 8291.0kHz Distress calling Next :Resends 4.1min later Stage :Waiting for ACK Call-F:2/4/6/8/12/16 Nature:Undesignated PosUTC: 89゚59.0123'N :179゚59.6789'E @23:59 Mode :Radiotelephone [FRQ][Pause][POS][CHNG][Cancel] SIG WKR 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 2182.0 2182.0 DST ALT RxID:123456789|OWN D-ACK|2MHz DIST acknowledged(00.2min) T x : 2|4|6|8|12|16/ U n d e s i g n a t e d / T E L 89゚59.0123'N179゚59.6789'E@23:59 Press CANCEL to silence alarm. xi 44.. After receiving acknowledgement, use the radiotelephone to request rescue. First, the responding station calls by radiotelephone. Communicate the following information to that station. z Say "MAYDAY". z Say "This is (name of your ship)". z Tell the station the ship's Maritime Mobile Service Identity (MMSI) number, call sign, ship's position, nature of distress, and rescue requests. Note If time permits, enter the nature of the distress or the mode (Radiotelephone or FEC) as follows, just before sending the distress alert. (For more details, see 4.5.5 Distress alerts.) 1) 2) 3) 4) Open menu 3. Editing a distress msg. Press ENT on the screen at right and select the nature of the distress. Press ENT to confirm the selection. The nature of the distress is set. If the position and time (UTC) are not displayed automatically for any reason, input them manually at this time. Press and hold the DISTRESS key for 4 seconds to send the distress alert. The rest of the procedure is the same as described above. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL Rx: 4146.0/Tx: 4146.0kHz 3)Editing a distress msg :[Undesignated ] Nature Position :[NE] [ 89゚59.0123'N] [179゚59.6789'E] UTC of pos :[23:59] Mode :[Radiotelephone] Attempt type:[Multi-FRQ ] Tx bands :[2/4/6/8/12/16] [Preview] [Tips] [Cancel] Terminating a Distress Alert CAUTION If a false distress alert is transmitted accidentally, select the Cancel menu and transmit the distress cancel referring the guidance displayed on the controller. And then report the false distress alert to a nearby RCC (Rescue Coordination Center/ in Japan, inform the nearest Japan Coast Guard.) Information to be reported: Ship's name, type, nationality, and ID number, the date/time, location and reason why the false distress alert was transmitted. Also the unit model name and manufacture number/date, if possible. Select the Cancel menu and press ENT on the NCM-2150 MF/HF CONTROLLER. The screen shown below is displayed. Then select Continue with the jog dial and press ENT to start the distress cancel procedure referring the guidance displayed on the controller. Note) For more details, see the description in the 4.5.5.1 Quick distress alerts. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) TEL Rx: 2182.0/Tx: 2182.0kHz Distress calling Next :Resends 3.2min later Stage :Waiting for ACK C a l l - F : 2 /! 4! /W 6a /r 8n /i 1n 2g /! 1! 6 Nature:Undesignated P o s UC Ta Cn :c e 8l 9 ゚t 5h 9e . 0t 1r 2a 3n 's Nm i t t e d f a l :s 1e 7 9d ゚i 5s 9t .r 6e 7s 8s 9 'a El e @r 2t 3? : 5 9 M o d e( T G :T R: a d2 i/ o4 t/ e6 l/ e8 p/ h1 o2 n/ e1 6 M ) [Continue] [Return] [FRQ][Pause][POS][CHNG][Cancel] SIG WKR 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz xii Receiving a Distress Alert WARNING If a distress alert is received, make sure to inform the ship's captain or officer in charge. Doing so may save the lives of the crew and passengers on the ship in distress. 11.. When a distress alert is received, the information such as the ID number of the ship in distress and the stage of the distress event are displayed. If the equipment is not used, i.e. there is no active procedure at that time, a distress and safety frequency is set and the ALM lamp starts blinking, and an alarm gradually grows louder. 22.. Press the CANCEL key to stop the alarm. If the popup screen is shown, select "Accept" and press ENT. After the specified communicate mode and the distress frequency are set, keep watch under such a condition. Keep watch for five minutes or more, and executes the report to the coast station etc. as appropriate ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL TEL 2182.0 2182.0 S A M E D S T O N A N O T AH ERR: DFSRTQ A L T From :123456789 Work-F : 8291.0kHz EQP will tune to the above FRQ within 10s. R x F R[ :A 1c 2c 3e 4p 5t 6] 7 8 9[ |I Dg In So Tr Re E] S S A L T Waiting to send ACK(00.2min) Single-FRQ: 2187.5kHz TEL :Rx 2182.0/Tx 2182.0kHz [ACK][RLY][INF][FRQ][HLD][END] 8291.0 8291.0 DST ALT RxID:123456789|DISTRESS ALT Waiting to send ACK(00.6min) Multi-FRQ:2/ / /8/ /16 TEL :Rx 8291.0/Tx 8291.0KHz [ACK][RLY][INF][FRQ][HLD][END] 33.. To acknowledge to the distress alert after coordination with the coast station, from the above right screen, press FUNC key to move the active screen to the message control area. Then select ACK with jog dial and press ENT to send the acknowledgement. After acknowledging the distress alert, communicate with the ship in distress as follows; z Say "MAYDAY". z Repeat the identity (MMSI) of the ship in distress 3 times z Say, "This is". z Repeat the identity (MMSI) of your ship 3 times z Say "RECEIVED MAYDAY". xiii Equipment exterior ● JSS-2250/2500 (JSS-2250N/2500N) 250W/500W MF/HF Radio Equipment Note: According to the composition, the model variants are as follows. JSS-2250 :250W Radiotelephone/ DSC JSS-2250N :250W Radiotelephone/ DSC & NBDP JSS-2500 :500W Radiotelephone/ DSC JSS-2500N :500W Radiotelephone/ DSC & NBDP In this document, unless otherwise specified, “JSS-2250/2500” may include “JSS-2250N/2500N”. NTD-2250/2500 Transceiver NBD-2250/2500 Power supply NFC-2250/2500 Antenna tuner NCM-2150 MF/HF Controller/NQW-261 Handset xiv NDZ-227 Data terminal / NDF-369 Keyboard NKG-800 Printer xv ● DPU-414 Printer ● NBB-714 Battery charger (10A) ● NCH-321A Distress Message Controller (DMC) xvi ● ● NKG-91 Printer NBB-724 Battery charger Contents Preface ......................................................................................................... Before operation ......................................................................................... Handling precautions vi ................................................................................. viii DISTRESS ALERTS .................................................................................... xi Equipment exterior ..................................................................................... xiv ....................................................................................... xxi Glossary of terms 1. EQUIPMENT OVERVIEW ........................................................................ 1-1 1.1 Functions ................................................................................................................... 1-1 1.2 Features ..................................................................................................................... 1-1 1.3 Basic configuration 1.3.1 .................................................................................................... 1-2 DSC model (JSS-2250/2500) ................................................................................ 1-2 1.3.1.1 Standard components .................................................................................. 1-2 1.3.1.2 Options ........................................................................................................... 1-2 DSC/NBDP model (JSS-2250N/2500N) ................................................................ 1-3 1.3.2 1.3.2.1 Standard components .................................................................................. 1-3 1.3.2.2 Options ........................................................................................................... 1-3 1.3.3 System configuration 1.4 External dimensions 1.5 Block diagram ........................................................................................... 1-4 .................................................................................................. 1-5 ............................................................................................................ 1-12 1.5.1 DSC model (JSS-2250/2500) ................................................................................ 1-12 1.5.2 DSC/NBDP model (JSS-2250N/2500N) ................................................................ 1-13 2. NAMES AND FUNCTIONS ...................................................................... 2-1 2.1 Controller (NCM-2150) .............................................................................................. 2-1 2.2 Controller’s display ...................................................................................................... 2-3 2.2.1 Status display ....................................................................................................... 2.2.2 Operating display 2.2.3 Function screen and key operations 2.2.4 Menu screen ................................................................................................. 2-3 2-4 .................................................................... 2-6 ........................................................................................................ 2-7 2.3 Data terminal(NDZ-227) ......................................................................................... 2-8 2.4 Display of data terminal ............................................................................................... 2-9 2.4.1 Regular screen 2.4.2 Telex communication screen 2.4.3 Message file edit screen 3. INSTALLATION ..................................................................................................... 2-9 ................................................................................ 2-10 ...................................................................................... 2-11 ........................................................................................ 3-1 4. OPERATION 4.1 ............................................................................................ 4-1 ................................................................................................... 4-1 4.1.1 Operation of the controller .................................................................................... 4-1 4.1.2 Operation of the data terminal ............................................................................. 4-4 Basic communications procedure ............................................................................. 4-6 .......................................................................................... 4-6 4.2 Operation overview 4.2.1 Turning on the power 4.2.2 Turning off the power/ Putting into sleep mode 4.2.3 Communicating in radiotelephone mode 4.2.4 Communicating in CW mode 4.2.5 Receiving AM broadcasts 4.2.6 Communicating in telex mode (TLX) 4.3 ................................................... 4-7 ............................................................ 4-8 .............................................................................. 4-10 .................................................................................... 4-12 ................................................................... 4-13 4.2.6.1 ARQ mode operation ................................................................................... 4-13 4.2.6.2 CFEC mode operation ................................................................................. 4-16 4.2.6.3 SFEC mode operation ................................................................................. 4-20 4.2.6.4 Editing telex messages ................................................................................ 4-22 ........................................................................................................ 4-25 Setting the radio 4.3.1 Setting the communication frequencies .............................................................. 4-25 4.3.2 Setting the communication channels .................................................................. 4-26 4.3.3 Setting the automatic gain control (AGC) 4.3.4 Setting the noise reduction (NR) 4.3.5 Setting the attenuation (ATT) ........................................................... 4-30 ......................................................................... 4-30 .............................................................................. 4-31 4.3.6 Setting the clarifier ............................................................................................... 4-31 4.3.7 Setting the squelch level ..................................................................................... 4-32 ................................................................................... 4-32 4.3.8 Setting the CW bandwidth 4.3.9 Scanning the Rx frequencies 4.3.10 Reducing the Tx power .............................................................................. 4-33 ....................................................................................... 4-35 4.3.11 Setting the antenna tuning power ....................................................................... 4.3.12 Setting the Auto Tune Start (ATS) function 4.4 4-35 .......................................................... 4-35 Basic DSC operations ................................................................................................. 4-36 4.4.1 Routine calls to an individual station ................................................................... 4-36 4.4.2 Receiving routine individual calls ........................................................................ 4-38 4.4.3 Routine group calls .............................................................................................. 4-40 4.4.4 Receiving routine group calls .............................................................................. 4-40 Emergency calls (DSC distress/urgency/safety calls) ................................................ 4-41 4.5 4.5.1 Safety or urgency calls to an individual station 4.5.1.1 4.5.2 Special safety individual calls ................................................... 4-41 ...................................................................... 4-41 Receiving safety or urgency individual calls 4.5.2.1 ....................................................... 4-43 ...................................................... 4-43 ................................................................................ 4-44 Receiving special safety individual calls 4.5.3 Safety or urgency area calls 4.5.4 Receiving safety or urgency area calls 4.5.5 Distress alerts ............................................................... 4-45 ...................................................................................................... 4-46 4.5.5.1 Quick distress alerts 4.5.5.2 Distress alerts from the menu 4.5.5.3 Receiving distress alerts 4.5.6 .................................................................................... 4-46 ...................................................................... 4-49 .............................................................................. 4-52 Distress relay calls on behalf of someone else (DROBOSE) ............................. 4-53 4.6 DSC call log ............................................................................................................... 4.6.1 Received distress messages 4.6.2 Received other messages 4.6.3 Transmitted messages 4-55 ............................................................................... 4-55 ................................................................................... 4-56 ......................................................................................... 4-56 4.7 Display of telex communication logs ......................................................................... 4-57 4.8 USB memory operation ............................................................................................. 4-58 4.9 Popup screens ........................................................................................................... 4-59 5. SETTINGS & REGISTRATIONS .............................................................. 5-1 ............................................................................................... 5-1 5.1 Date and time settings 5.2 Own ship position and time settings 5.3 Controller settings .......................................................................... 5-3 ...................................................................................................... 5-4 5.3.1 LCD adjustment ................................................................................................... 5-4 5.3.2 Sound settings ..................................................................................................... 5-4 5.3.3 User key assignments 5.3.4 Selecting Tx meters 5.3.5 Transferring user channel data to another controller 5.3.6 Setting the inactivity timer (for menu shutdown) 5.3.7 Setting the reference value for the channel auto search .......................................................................................... 5-5 ............................................................................................. 5-6 ........................................... 5-7 .................................................. 5-8 ..................................... 5-8 ......................................................................................... 5-9 5.4 Registering user channels 5.5 Advanced settings for DSC/WKR .............................................................................. 5-11 5.5.1 Automatic acknowledgement ............................................................................... 5-11 5.5.2 Setting DSC watch frequency .............................................................................. 5-11 5.5.3 Setting receiving alarms ....................................................................................... 5-12 5.5.4 Using medical/neutral settings for urgency calls 5.5.5 Registering the ship's group ID 5.5.6 Setting the inactivity timer (for procedures on hold) 5.5.7 .................................................. 5-12 ............................................................................ 5-12 ............................................ 5-13 Registering the DSC call list ................................................................................ 5-13 5.6 Setting connections for options 5.7 Setting of data terminal ................................................................................. 5-14 .............................................................................................. 5-15 ................................................................................................... 5-15 5.7.1 LCD adjustment 5.7.2 Registering station list 5.8 Setting telex mode .......................................................................................... 5-17 ..................................................................................................... 5-19 6. MAINTENANCE & INSPECTION ............................................................. 6-1 ............................................................................ 6-1 Self diagnosis inspection ........................................................................................... 6-2 System alarm indication ............................................................................................ 6-5 .............................................................................................................. 6-6 6.1 General maintenance & inspection 6.2 6.3 6.3.1 Alarm list 6.3.2 Viewing the alarm history ..................................................................................... 6-9 6.4 Software version ........................................................................................................ 6-10 6.5 Troubleshooting ......................................................................................................... 6-11 6.5.1 Procedures for locating malfunctions ................................................................... 6-11 6.5.2 Guide to locating faults ........................................................................................ 6-12 6.5.3 Consumables ....................................................................................................... 6-13 6.5.4 Repair units/parts 6.5.5 Regular replacement parts ................................................................................................. ................................................................................... 6-13 6-14 7. AFTER-SALES SERVICE 8. DISPOSAL ....................................................................... 7-1 ............................................................................................... 8-1 9. SPECIFICATIONS ................................................................................... 9.1 JSS-2250/2500 MF/HF Radio Equipment 9.2 Options 9.3 Peripheral interfaces 9-1 ................................................................ 9-1 ...................................................................................................................... 9-5 ................................................................................................. 10. OPTIONS OPERATION 9-7 ......................................................................... 10-1 10.1 Battery charger (NBB-714) ....................................................................................... 10-1 10.2 Battery charger (NBB-724) ....................................................................................... 10-3 10.3 Printer (NKG-91) ....................................................................................................... 10-5 10.4 Printer (NKG-800) ..................................................................................................... 10-6 10.5 Operations using a SELCALL unit 11. Appendix ............................................................................ 10-9 ............................................................................................... 11-1 11.1 Frequencies for distress and safety calls 11.2 National DSC frequencies for routine calls .................................................................. ............................................................... 11.3 International DSC frequencies for routine calls 11-2 ........................................................ 11-2 ................................................................................ 11-3 ........................................................................................ 11-23 11.4 ITU channel list (TEL/CW/TLX) 11.5 Guide to MF/HF operation 11-1 Declaration on toxic & hazardous substances or elements Marking with market circulation mark Glossary of terms This section defines general and DSC terms related to this equipment. ● General terms AMVER Automated Mutual-assistance Rescue System Vessel System that informs another ship of position of distress ship operated in the United States. ARQ Automatic Repeat reQuest When communicating interactive in the telex mode, this ARQ is used. CFEC Collective Forward Error Correction When broadcasting in the telex mode, this CFEC is used. DSC Digital Selective Calling device Used in routine calls, safety and urgency calls, and distress alerts for rescue requests. GMDSS Global Maritime Distress and Safety System. GPS Global Positioning system IMO International Maritime Organization ITU International Telecommunication Union Establishes conventions and regulations for all electrical wired and radio, land, sea, air, and space communications. It contains internal organizations such as ITU-R and ITU-T. ITU-R The International Telecommunications Union (ITU) radio communications department. JASREP Japanese Ship Reporting System Ship position reporting system operated in Japan. LT Local time MF/HF Medium frequencies and high frequencies (300 kHz to 30 MHz) MMSI Maritime Mobile Service Identity The 9-digit Maritime Mobile Service Identity number assigned to each ship and coast station. NBDP Narrow Band Direct Printing It is a generic name of the device used to communicate in the telex mode. NMEA Maritime equipment transmission standard established by the National Marine Electronics Association. PTT Push to talk RCC Rescue Co-ordinate Center RMS Remote Maintenance System Transmits ship equipment information temporarily stored in the VDR via Inmarsat to land, for use in maintenance and management of radio equipment. RR Radio Regulations International regulations for radio transmission established by the treaty of the ITU. SELCAL Number(Selective Calling Number) Selective Calling Number by NBDP. It is the numbers of four digits (coast station) or five digits (Ship station) used when the other party is specified in the telex mode. xxi SFEC Selective Forward Error Correction When broadcasting to a specific group in the telex mode, this SFEC is used. SOLAS Convention International Convention for Safety of Life at Sea The international convention applies to all ships engaged on international voyages. A safety certificate is issued if the conditions of this convention are satisfied. SQL Squelch A function that acts to suppress the audio output of a receiver in the absence of a radio signal of sufficient strength. UTC Universal Time Coordinated VOL (Volume) Speaker volume WRC World Radiocommunication Conference WKR Watch Keeping Receiver The WKR is the receiver dedicated to monitoring the distress and safety frequencies. ● DSC terms Address General term for Maritime Mobile Serive Identity number (MMSI). This equipment uses To/From to distinguish between the sender and receiver. It also means the Self-ID (own ship MMSI) and Dist-ID (MMSI of a ship in distress). Category Message code indicating priority of the call. Priority levels are listed below. ・ Routine… General calls for routine work ・ Safety… Calls for safety communications ・ Urgency… Calls for urgent communications ・ Distress… Calls for distress communications DROBOSE Distress relay call (to individual or to area) on behalf of someone else who is in distress. EOS (End Of Sequence) Termination code appended to call messages. Other codes are listed below. ・ ACK RQ… Acknowledgement request ・ ACK BQ… Acknowledgement responding to the ACK RQ ECC (Error Check Character) Error check code appended to the end of call messages. This is not normally displayed, but if an error occurs on a message, an ECC error is displayed. xxii Mode Message code indicating communication mode after a DSC call. This equipment is fixed to radiotelephone. Radiotelephone (TEL) or ARQ and FEC (TLX) can be used. Nature of Distress Message code indicating the type of distress when a distress alert is issued. Codes are listed below. ・ Fire… Fire, explosion ・ Flooding… Flooding ・ Collision… Collision ・ Grounding… Grounding ・ Listing… Risk of ship capsizing ・ Sinking… Sinking ・ Disabled… Ship inoperable/adrift ・ Undesignated… Undesignated distress ・ Abandoning… Abandoning ship ・ Piracy attack… Piracy/robbery attack ・ Man overboard… Man overboard Polling Polling is a feature for routine calling. It is used, for example, to confirm whether a ship is within radio range when a coast station requests navigational information of the ship. Reason Message code indicating reason for negative acknowledgement response. Codes are listed below. ・ No reason… ・ Congestion… ・ Busy… ・ Queue… ・ Barred… ・ No operator… ・ Temp no oper… ・ EQP disabled… ・ Unable FRQ… ・ Unable mode… No reason Maritime information exchange center congested Busy Queued Station barred No operator Temporarily no operator Equipment disabled Indicated frequency cannot be used Indicated mode cannot be used Rx FRQ Received frequency of the call Subject/ Sub Message code clarifying communication contents when sending an urgency call to all ships. When sailing in dangerous waters, such as in areas of political instability, these call messages are used with the following information. ・ Neutral ship: In accordance with ITU resolution 18 (Mob-83), inform all ships that own ship is of neutral nationality. ・ Medical TRANSP: Inform all ships that own ship is performing medical transportation, and is protected under the 1949 Geneva Convention. Type Message code indicating the type of the call. Codes are listed below. ・ Individual call… Individual call message ・ Individual ACK… Acknowledgement of individual call message ・ Individual NACK… Negative acknowledgement of individual call message ・ Group call… Group call message ・ GEO area call… Area call message ・ All ships call… Call to all ships ・ Distress… Distress alert message ・ Distress ACK… Acknowledgement of distress alert message ・ Distress relay… Distress relay message ・ Distress relay ACK… Acknowledgement of distress relay message ・ Distress relay GEO… Area call of distress relay message Intent Message code indicating specific content. Indicates the type of the call for a specific purpose, not for radiotelephone communication. ・ Polling… Polling ・ Position RQ… Ship position request ・ Ship position… Ship position notification ・ Test… Safety test call Work FRQ/ WFRQ Message code indicating communication frequency after a DSC call. Topic Message codes in an acknowledged message After sending an individual call, "Unable to comply" is displayed when the responding station cannot comply. xxiii xxiv Equipment Overview 1. EQUIPMENT OVERVIEW 1.1 Functions This equipment includes MF/HF transceiver, Class-A DSC and DSC watch keeping receiver required as the Global Maritime Distress and Safety System (GMDSS). It is designed as a separated transceiver and small, lightweight controller(s) for easy installation not only in SOLAS Convention ships such as international passenger ships and freight ships of 300 tons or more, but also non-conventional ships of less than 300 tons. As for the main communication function, in addition to the communications of radiotelephone with the handset and the Morse communication with the CW keyer, calling by digital selective calling (DSC) for a general or distress communication are possible. Furthermore, if the data terminal is connected to the controller, the telex communication in the ARQ or FEC mode using the NBDP is available. 1.2 Features ● Compliant with the ITU Radio Regulations (RR), the IMO performance standards, and the ITU-R recommendations. ● Contains all channels specified in the ITU Radio Regulations (RR). ● The separately designed controller and main unit enable easy installation in limited or difficult spaces. ● A semi-transmissive LCD with a wide viewing angle is easily viewable even in direct light or when backlit and allows it to be installed in a variety of positions. ● The backlights of the LCD and operation keys are fully adjustable, preventing interference with night watch keeping. ● When in distress, the DSC can send a distress message with the expanded position data accurate up to 1/10000 of a minute for both latitude and longitude to make search and rescue operations by the RCC easier. ● High-quality stable operation is possible by using DSP technology on a transceiver with a DSC/WKR modem. ● The DSC operates in Class A mode suitable for all areas, and in Class B mode limited to ships navigating in A1 and A2 areas. ● An advanced digital audio amplifier with a built-in loud speaker provides a maximum of 5 W of clear audio. ● The maintenance and the check can be easily done at daily or the regular services, because a special function key was prepared for the DSC safety test calling and the self-diagnosis. ● It is possible to operate on the screen with the character color and the background color corresponding to the favor because the data terminal for the telex communication by NBDP adopted the color liquid crystal display of the wide viewing angle in high brightness. ● Besides printers and GPS, other peripherals such as the remote maintenance system (RMS) can be connected to the equipment. 1-1 Equipment Overview 1.3 Basic configuration 1.3.1 1.3.1.1 DSC model (JSS-2250/2500) Standard components No. 3-1 3-2 1.3.1.2 Description Transceiver Power supply MF/HF controller Controller cable Handset Antenna tuner Instruction manual Model NTD-2250/2500 NBD-2250/2500 NCM-2150 7ZCJD0343 NQW-261 NFC-2250/2500 7ZPJD0622 Qty Notes For 250W and 500W respectively For 250W and 500W respectively 5m Includes the cradle For 250W and 500W respectively This manual Options No. Description Model Notes Battery charger NBB-724 22A Battery charger NBB-714 10A *For maintenance-free sealed battery only For both RX and WKR Joint box JQD-69C Junction box NQD-2253 Coaxial connector M-P-7, M-A-JJ For RG-12/UY and RG-10/UY 6-1 6-2 6-3 MF/HF controller Controller cable Handset Flush mounting bracket NCM-2150 7ZCJD0343 NQW-261 MPBC42957 One additional controller available. 5m Waterproof type (IP66 equivalent) 6-4 6-5 Mounting bracket Connection box MPBX44354 NQD-2250 Printer NKG-800/900 7-1 Printer connection cable 6ZCSC00407 7-2 Printer power cable 6JNKD00100B 7-3 Printer paper 5ZPCM00020 7-4 Ink ribbon (SP-16051) 5ZZCM00003 Printer NKG-91 8-1 Printer connection cable 7ZCJD0254A 8-2 Printer paper 7ZPJD0384 8-3 Wall mounting bracket MPBP31446 Printer DPU-414 9-1 Printer connection cable 7ZCJD0254A 9-2 Printer power cable 7ZCJD0257C 9-3 Printer paper 6ZCAF00252A 10 Distress message controller NCH-321A 1-2 For extension and expansion of the controller Desktop type Wall mount or flush mount type Desktop type Equipment Overview 1.3.2 1.3.2.1 No. 3-1 3-2 5-1 5-2 5-3 6-1 6-2 1.3.2.2 No. 6-1 6-2 6-3 6-4 6-5 7-1 7-2 7-3 7-4 7-5 8-1 8-2 8-3 8-4 9-1 9-2 9-3 10 10-1 10-2 10-3 11 DSC/NBDP model (JSS-2250N/2500N) Standard components Description Transceiver Power supply MF/HF controller Controller cable Handset Antenna tuner Data terminal DTE cable DTE power cable Keyboard Printer Printer connection cable Printer power cable Instruction manual Model NTD-2250/2500 NBD-2250/2500 NCM-2150 7ZCJD0343 NQW-261 NFC-2250/2500 NDZ-227 7ZCJD0388 7ZCJD0419 NDF-369 NKG-800 7ZCSC0205A 6JNKD00100B 7ZPJD0622 Qty Notes For 250W and 500W respectively For 250W and 500W respectively 5m Includes the cradle For 250W and 500W respectively NBDP option This manual Options Description Battery charger Battery charger Joint box Junction box Coaxial connector MF/HF controller Controller cable Handset Flush mounting bracket Mounting bracket Connection box Data terminal DTE cable DTE power cable Keyboard Mounting bracket USB memory Printer Printer connection cable Printer power cable Printer paper Ink ribbon (SP-16051) Printer Printer connection cable Printer paper Wall mounting bracket Printer Printer connection cable Printer power cable Printer paper Distress message controller Model NBB-724 NBB-714 JQD-69C NQD-2253 M-P-7, M-A-JJ NCM-2150 7ZCJD0343 NQW-261 MPBC42957 MPBX44354 NQD-2250 NDZ-227 7ZCJD0388 7ZCJD0419 NDF-369 MPBP31721 UDG4-1GAR-JRC NKG-800/900 7ZCSC0205A 6JNKD00100B 5ZPCM00020 5ZZCM00003 NKG-91 7ZCJD0254A 7ZPJD0384 MPBP31446 DPU-414 7ZCJD0254A 7ZCJD0257C 6ZCAF00252A NCH-321A Notes 22A 10A *For maintenance-free sealed battery only For both RX and WKR For RG-12/UY and RG-10/UY One additional controller available. 5m Waterproof type (IP66 equivalent) For extension and expansion of the controller For expansion of the controller Hagiwara Sys-Com / 1GB Desktop type Wall mount or flush mount type Desktop type 1-3 Equipment Overview 1.3.3 System configuration NKG-800 Printer NCM-2150 MF/HF Controller NQW-261 Handset NDZ-227 Data terminal NDF-369 Keyboard (DSC/NBDP model only) Expansion Controller NTD-2250/2500 Transceiver GPS NBD-2250/2500 Power supply NFC-2250/2500 Antenna Tuner NCH-321A DMC NBB-724 Battery charger * The equipment can also be connected to the VDR server to use the remote maintenance system. 1-4 Equipment Overview 1.4 External dimensions Below are the external dimensions of each unit. (1) Transceiver (NTD-2250/2500) Unit: mm Weight: Approx. 15 kg/ 17 kg Note) This figure shows the NTD-2250. Incase of the NTD-2500, 3 fans are mounted on the back. (2) Power Supply (NBD-2250/2500) Unit: mm Weight: Approx. 15 kg/ 18 kg 1-5 Equipment Overview (3) MF/HF Controller (NCM-2150) Unit: mm Weight: Approx. 1.3 kg (4) Handset (NQW-261) Mounting hole (5) Unit: mm Weight: Approx. 0.5 kg Connection box (NQD-2250) Unit: mm Weight: Approx. 0.6 kg 1-6 Equipment Overview (6) Antenna Tuner (NFC-2250/2500) Unit: mm Weight: Approx. 10 kg/ 10 kg (7) Junction Box (NQD-2253) Unit: mm Weight: Approx. 1.2 kg 1-7 Equipment Overview (8) Data Terminal (NDZ-227) Unit: mm Weight: Approx. 4.6 kg (9) Keyboard (NDF-369) Unit: mm Weight: Approx. 0.4 kg 1-8 Equipment Overview (10) Printer (NKG-800) ● Desktop type Unit: mm Weight: Approx. 3.7 kg (11) Printer (DPU-414) ● Desktop type Unit: mm Weight: Approx. 0.6 kg 1-9 Equipment Overview (12) Printer (NKG-91) ● Wall mount type Unit: mm Weight: Approx. 1.5 kg ● Flash mount type Unit: mm Weight: Approx. 0.8 kg 1-10 Equipment Overview (13) Battery Charger (NBB-714) Unit: mm Weight: Approx. 8.6 kg (14) Battery Charger (NBB-724) Unit: mm Weight: Approx. 12 kg 1-11 Equipment Overview 1.5 Block diagram 1.5.1 DSC model (JSS-2250/2500) Rx/WKR antenna Tx antenna JQD-69C Joint box Lead wire TH-19/1.2 RG-12/UY NQW-261 Handset M-P-7 NCM-2150 MF/HF Controller 7ZCJD 0343 (5m) TTYCS- 4 DPYC-2.5 M-P-7 NTD-2250/2500 Transceiver NQD-2250 Connection box 6.5V DC RX/WKR ANT TX ANT M-P-7/M-P-5 M-A-JJ RG-10/UY TX ANT 7ZCJD 0426 NFC-2250/2500 Antenna tuner TTYCYS-4 NQD-2253 Junction box NBD-2250/2500 Power supply 7ZCJD0254A NBB-724 Battery charger NKG-91 Printer DPYC-16 100V/220V AC 50/60Hz 1φ DPYC-25 24V DC 200Ah TTYCS- 4 DPYC-2.5 NQD-2250 Connection box TTYCS- 1 Expansion controller MPYCS- 7 NCH-321A DMC TTYCS- 1 RMS (VDR) TTYCS- 4 1-12 GPS AME Equipment Overview 1.5.2 DSC/NBDP model (JSS-2250N/2500N) Rx/WKR antenna Tx antenna JQD-69C Joint box Lead wire TH-19/1.2 RG-12/UY NQW-261 Handset M-P-7 NCM-2150 MF/HF Controller 7ZCJD 0343 (5m) TTYCS- 4 DPYC-2.5 M-P-7 NTD-2250/2500 Transceiver NQD-2250 Connection box 7ZCJD0419 RX/WKR ANT TX ANT M-P-7/M-P-5 M-A-JJ RG-10/UY TX ANT 7ZCJD 0426 NFC-2250/2500 Antenna tuner TTYCYS-4 NQD-2253 Junction box NBD-2250/2500 Power supply 7ZCJD0388 NBB-724 Battery charger NDZ-227 Data terminal DPYC-16 100V/220V AC 50/60Hz 1φ DPYC-25 24V DC 200Ah NDF-369 Keyboard 7ZCSC0205A 6JNKD00100B NKG-800 Printer TTYCS- 4 DPYC-2.5 NQD-2250 Connection box TTYCS- 1 Expansion controller GPS MPYCS- 7 NCH-321A DMC TTYCS- 1 RMS (VDR) TTYCS- 4 AME 1-13 Equipment Overview 1-14 Names and Functions 2. NAMES AND FUNCTIONS 2.1 Controller (NCM-2150) The controller parts and their functions are described below. 10 11 12 13 14 1. Internal loud speaker 2. Jack for telegraph in continuous wave (CW) mode 3. Black and white liquid crystal display unit 4. Numeric keypad (10-key) and function keys 15 16 In addition to entering numeric values, when combined with the FUNC key, the keys have the following functions. ・ TEL ··· Sets TEL mode with the last or default frequency. ・ DSC ··· Sets DSC mode with the last or default frequency. ・ CW ··· Sets CW mode with the last or default frequency. ・ 1 CLAR ··· Displays the setting screen for the clarifier. ・ 2 SCAN ··· Displays the scan menu. ・ 3 NR ··· Displays the setting screen for noise reduction. ・ 4 ATT ··· Displays the setting screen for attenuation. ・ 5 AGC ··· Displays the setting screen for automatic gain control. ・ 6 SP ··· Turns speaker on or off. ・ 7 PRN ··· Prints the specified screen. ・ 8 TEST ··· Displays the self-diagnosis menu. ・ 9 PW R RDC ··· Switches Tx power between high, medium and low. ・ 0 TEST CALL ··· Displays the DSC test call menu. ・ FUNC ··· Enables 10-key functions or changes an active screen. 2-1 Names and Functions ・ ENT ····· Enter key. ・ USER ····· User defined key. Register a frequently used menu to open it quickly. ・ ANT TUNE ····· Tunes the antenna. ・ CH ····· Sets the channel input mode (user channel, ITU channel, or free frequency). 5. Jog dial - On the status display, rotating the jog dial changes the channel or Rx frequency. - On the operating display, rotating the jog dial changes the frequency on the transceiver setting screen, selects the event on the procedure list screen, or selects the handling menu on the message/event control screen. - On a menu or popup screen, rotating the jog dial moves the cursor position or screen contents. When selecting a button or an item on the screen, rotate the jog dial until the cursor is on it and then press the jog dial. Note Pressing the jog dial works as with the Enter key. 6. Handset connector 7. DISTRESS key (Under a clear cover with spring) When in distress, sends a DSC distress alert when pressed and held for 4 seconds. 8. RF GAIN control Adjusts sensitivity level. Note RF GAIN is set to maximum just after DSC or TLX mode is set, regardless of the position of the control. 9. DIM (Dimmer) key Adjusts dimmer level (Max → Typ → Min → Off) of the LCD display and key switches. Additionally used to put into sleep mode by pressing it in combination with the PW R CONT key at the same time (a confirmation screen is displayed). Note ・ The adjusted dimmer level is not saved. When the controller is powered off and on again, the dimmer level is always set to Typ (default). ・ If a DSC message is received, the dimmer adjustment cycle becomes "Max → Typ → Typ → Typ" while the receiving alarm is activated. 10. PWR/CONT (Power/Contrast) key Turns on the equipment or changes the controller from sleep mode to standby. Once turned on, this key is also used to adjust the LCD contrast. 11. VOL (Volume) control Adjusts volume of built-in loud speaker. 12. ALM/WKR (Alarm/Watchkeeping receiver) lamp Lights up red on any malfunction detected in the equipment or after sending a DSC distress alert, or blinks red on receiving a DSC call. Lights green to indicate the DSC watchkeeping receiver is operating while the equipment is in sleep mode. 13. CANCEL key Cancels menus, a procedure on the operating display or stops alarms. 14. MENU key Displays menu list. 15. Handset When using in radiotelephone mode, press and hold the PTT key to talk. 16. Cradle (for handset) 2-2 Names and Functions 2.2 Controller’s display The LCD screen on the controller changes according to current conditions. This section describes the status display, operating display, FUNC menu, and main menu screens. 2.2.1 Status display TEL ITU- 401 RX 4357.0 kHz TX 4065.0 kHz 10 1. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) Occupied mark. Indicates another controller has the access rights. 2. Indicates the ship's MMSI. 3. Indicates the ship's position and that time. 4. Indicates the communication mode and channel. 5. Indicates the receiver is scanning. 6. Indicates the Tx power condition (reduction settings) as follows. z High : (Blank) z Medium z Low 7. Indicates the following conditions if Tx frequency is not tuned. z Not tuned : Blinks z Tuning : Lights z Tuned : (Blank) 8. Indicates transmission status (PA power). 9. When in reception or standby, indicates strength of received signal (S meter), or when in transmission, indicates strength of transmitted signal in one of the pre-set units shown below. z Tx power (PWR) z Antenna current (Ia) z PA voltage (Vc) z PA current (Ic) z Key information (KEY) Note: When transmitting in ARQ mode, KEY is displayed regardless of the above mentioned setting. Additionally, the right icon indicates the built-in loud speaker is on or off. The mark of indicates the squelch is on. 13 14 15 16 17 SIG NonDST: WKR scan bands: D R OB O S : 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz E d tD S T : 11 12 18 19 10. Indicates the frequency (band) the DSC watch keeping receiver is monitoring for distress and safety calls. 11. Indicates the equipment is running on DC power. 12. Indicates current time as follows: z Universal time coordinated : UTC z Local time : LT 13. Indicates the source of the ship's position information as follows. z External device (e.g. GPS) : EXT z Manual input : MAN z No input : OFFLINE 14. Indicates the user channel in use is transmitted at the band power level because the channel power is not registered. 15. Indicates channel or frequency is duplex for communicating with a coast station. 16. Indicates the reception frequency. 17. Indicates the transmission frequency. TX mark is highlighted when transmitting. 18. Indicates the reception status (attenuation, AGC, noise reduction). 19. Indicates the operation guidance (shortcut) to send the DSC messages. z NonDST: To send a non-distress alert, holding down the MENU, press 1 key. z DROBOS: To send a drobose call, holding down the MENU, press 2 key. z EdtDST: To edit & send a distress alert, holding down the MENU, press 3 key. 2-3 Names and Functions 2.2.2 Operating display (1) General After setting the frequency, pressing PTT key in TEL mode, sending/receiving messages in DSC/TLX mode, and things like that, the controller shows the operating display as follows. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 13077.0 12230.0 UP Communicating on TEL Rx:13077.0/Tx:12230.0kHz Tip)Use FUNC to change op area. [HLD][END] 1. Indicates the MMSI and the latest position and that time. 2. Indicates an focused screen with sign and thick-frame, i.e. the operating display is divided into three screens as below, where the focused screen can be moved using the FUNC key for clockwise. Transceiver setting 4. Indicates the S meter and watchkeeping receiver monitoring frequencies mentioned above. 5. Indicates the existing procedures. If the procedure is under operation (active), A mark is added in the box frame. Further, if other procedures on hold exist, they are indicated in the other box frames and are selectable to operate at any time. And while this screen is focused, the turning dial animation is shown as below. Procedure list ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) Message/event TEL 13077.0 12230.0 control 3. Indicates the transceiver setting screen similar to the status display. Icons on this area are as follows. z Scanning z Not tuned yet z Tx power reduction z Turned the PA ON z Attenuation (dB) z AGC ( Fast/ Slow) z Noise reduction (NR1/NR2/BC) : Note 2-4 UP Communicating on TEL Rx:13077.0/Tx:12230.0kHz Tip)Use FUNC to change op area. [HLD][END] 6. Indicates the content and the handling menus of the procedure located at the top of the procedure list screen. During operating an active procedure, any functions such like the DSC automatic acknowledgement become invalid to avoid the ongoing communication interruption. Names and Functions (2) Operating display of DSC calls When communicating using DSC messages, the controller shows as follows. 1. 2. Indicates the transceiver setting screen similar to the status display mentioned above. 4. Indicates procedures information of active or on hold with the DSC categories or COM. Note Indicates the message info as follows; ¾ Destination/source ID to comm with: TxTO/RxID ¾ Address type: IND, Area, GRP, All ¾ Category or DST type: RTN, SAF, URG, DST DISTRESS ALT, DST RLY, ¾ Other information: ACK, NACK Indicates the message type according to the following components. ¾ Call direction : Calling event Called event ¾ Category : RTN… routine SAF… safety URG… urgency DST… distress ¾ Address type : IND… individual ARE… area GRP… group ¾ DST type : ALT… distress alert RLY… distress relay CNL… distress cancel ACK… distress ack ¾ Other type : TST… safety test POS… safety position POLL… routine polling EOS… routine ind w/o ack Additionally, indicates COMM if started communication without using DSC. 3. 5. Indicates the DSC message status with the elapsed time of the top frame procedure. Additionally the following special marks may be indicated on this line. E … Indicates when including the ECC error in the message. D … Indicates when the DSC procedure is started by receiving a delayed ACK without a calling message. 6. Indicates the message received frequency. 7. Indicates the subsequent frequency if exist. 8. Indicates the handling menus. This figure shows the following menus. ¾ ¾ ¾ ¾ ¾ ¾ ACK NCK NEW INF HLD END : Accepts the call and sends ACK : Sends “unable to comply” : Sends ACK with new work FRQ : Indicates the detail info : Makes the active proc on hold : Terminates the procedure - When sending the “able to comply” acknowledgement against the received message requesting the TEL communication, lifting handset is also available as a substitute for selecting the ACK handling menu. - When selecting the NEW or NCK menu, the dedicated popup screen is appeared. - When sending an acknowledgement automatically to the receiving calls such as position request, safety test, polling, or the call requesting communication with an invalid frequency, the above screen is shown and starts sending automatically. After finishing it, that screen is closed automatically. 2-5 Names and Functions 2.2.3 Function screen and key operations The functions assigned to the number keys are temporarily enabled by pressing the FUNC key in the status display or holding down the FUNC key and pressing the number key. 1 CLAR : 2 SCAN : 3 NR 4 ATT 5 AGC : 6 SP 7 N/A 8 TEST : PW R 9 RDC 0 TstCall : FuncCncl : Displays the clarifier adjustment menu Displays the scan menu Displays the noise reduction menu Displays the attenuation menu Displays the AGC menu Turns the built-in loud speaker on or off PRN is valid only on specific menus. Displays the self-diagnosis menu Displays the Tx power reduction menu Displays the DSC test call menu Closes this screen 1. Indicates the enabled number key and its function when the FUNC key is pressed in the status display. Pressing the number keys here operates the function for that key as shown at the right. 2. Indicates that pressing ENT enables or disables the use of the jog dial to change the frequency and channel in the status display. Note Equipment status - During the operating display mentioned above, the function screen is not appeared. In this case the FUNC key alone is available to select the screen. However note that the holding down the FUNC key and pressing the number key is also valid. - In the following situations the function assigned to the function key cannot be used. 1 CLAR 2 SCAN 3 NR 4 ATT 5 AGC 6 SP 7 PRN 8 TEST PW R RDC TEST CALL DSC mode ● While printing ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● During self-diagnosis ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● While scanning ● While alarm screen is displayed ● 2-6 ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Names and Functions 2.2.4 Menu screen ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL Rx:13077.0/Tx:12230.0kHz Main menu 1.DSC non-distress call 2.DSC drobose call 3.Editing a distress msg 4.DSC logs 5.Radio operation 6.Maintenance 7.Setup 0.Back 1. Indicates the current menu name. 2. Indicates the menu content. The cursor line or position is highlighted. Select items with the jog dial and press ENT to confirm. 3. Indicates the main radio information the same as the status display. Also indicates the following marks in the frequency information area according to the conditions. : Performing the antenna tuning (Blinking means “Not tuned”.) M : Tx power is Medium. : Tx power is low. 2-7 Names and Functions 2.3 Data terminal(NDZ-227) This section describes the name of each part in the data terminal and the function. 1. Color liquid crystal display (LCD) unit 2. POWER lamp This lamp lights to green while operating the data terminal, and blinks during the sleep. 3. READY lamp This lamp lights to green while serial communications are being normally done. And, when abnormality occurs, it turns off. 4. COMM lamp This lamp lights to green while communicating in ARQ or FEC mode. 5. DIM (Dimmer) key This key adjusts the brightness of the LCD screen and the lamp by four stages (high, middle, low, and off). 6. Connector for the USB memory with the water-proof rubber cap Pull out the rubber cap and connect the USB memory. 7. Keyboard 2-8 Names and Functions 2.4 Display of data terminal The content displayed on the LCD screen in the data terminal is different according to the situation. This section describes a regular screen, the telex communication screen, and the message file edit screen. 2.4.1 Regular screen [TLX] Tx= 2174.5kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz File Tune USB Connect Free sig. S TS -T B- YB Y Scanning info [No scanning] Service Calling STATUS INFO Receive Rephasing System Repeat Help Traf Tuner/Tx.POWER TUNER :[READY] Tx.POWER :[HIGH] Last status message 10 Move the cursor to the item you want with ↑, ↓, →, ← then press Enter. File manager. Information:MEM KBD PRN USB (Press the+I if you want to know detail.) 1. Indicates the Tx and Rx frequencies. 2. Indicates the communication mode. 3. Indicates the main menu. When pressing the Enter key, indicates the drop-down menu of the main menu pointed by the cursor. ※Telex mode only. 4. Indicates the conditions communication. ※Telex mode only. 5. Indicates the scanning information in telex mode. When restarting scanning after sending a DSC Auto-ACK or powering off/on, indicates “Running now” instead of the detail information. ※Telex mode only. 6. of the 7. Indicates the guide according to the cursor position. Moreover, the locating faults are displayed if any errors occur. z Information: MEM :Internal memory z Information: KBD :Keyboard control z Information: PRN :Printer z Information: USB :USB Memory 8. Indicates that the connected USB memory is available. Additionally, “ACS” is shown if some time is needed to mount the USB memory. 9. Indicates the antenna tuning condition. z READY :Tuned z NOT READY :Not tuned telex 10. Indicates the power reduction setting. Indicates the operation result such as the self-diagnosis. 2-9 Names and Functions 2.4.2 Telex communication screen [TLX] Tx= 2174.5kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz Free sig. A RA QR Q USB TELEX Terminal Window Calling Rephasing Send Repeat Traf Message start... 1. 2-10 F2 WRU | F3 Hereis | F4 TMS | F5 Over | F8 F.Send | F10 Stop Indicates the operating condition of the telex communication from the left of each segment as follows. 1) In the autotelex mode, when the free channel signal of the coast station is detected, indicates the “Free Sig”. 2) Indicates the communication mode (ARQ/CFEC/SFEC). ※ Indicates “ST-BY” in the standby condition. 3) Indicates “Calling” at the master station, and “Called” at the slave station. 4) Indicates “Send” at the information sending station, and “Receive” at the information receiving station. 5) Indicates "Phasing" while calling and connecting the communication channel and “Rephasing” while reconnecting the channel after the channel is disconnected due to the channel condition in ARQ mode. 6) Indicates “Repeat” in ARQ mode if requested to send the each block or the control signal again. 7) Indicates “Traf” while sending or receiving information and “RQ” while sending or receiving RQ signal. 2. Indicates the telex message or the name of the executed function key. 3. Indicates the usable function keys guide. Each meaning is as follows. z F2 WRU : Requests the answerback code to the corresponding station. z F3 Hereis : Sends the answerback code of own station. z F4 TMS : Sends the date and the time information. z F5 Over : Exchange the sending and the receiving condition. z F6 POLL : Acquires the sending right if the corresponding station (sending) tries to finish the communication in ARQ mode. ※ It is available only when the corresponding station is using the modem made of our company. z F8 F.Send : Sends a message file. z F10 Stop : Finishes the telex communication. Names and Functions 2.4.3 Message file edit screen MF HF 1. [TLX] Tx= 2174.5kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz Editing telex file:001.TLX USB Line: 1 Column: 1 Size: 0 Insert On [End of File] F1:Insert Off F2:Ins_Line F7:Quit F3:Block F8:Save As Indicates the state of the edit screen as follows. z Editing telex file :File name z Line :Line position of cursor z Column :Row position of cursor z Size :Capacity of file z Insert On/Overwrite :Input mode (insert/overwrite) 2. The message file is edited here. 3. The list of the function key is displayed by the following content separately for two groups. z Group 1 ・ F1 :Insert On/Off ・ F2 :Ins_Line ・ F3 :Block ・ F4 :Del_Word ・ F5 :Del_Line F4:Del_Word F9:Save & Quit F5:Del_Line F10: - Others - ・ F6 : ・ F7 :Quit ・ F8 :Save As ・ F9 :Save & Quit ・ F10 :- Others Group 2 ・ F1 :Max Column ・ F2 :Set Tab ・ F3 :Undo_Char ・ F4 :Undo_Word ・ F5 :Undo_Line ・ F6 :Merge File ・ F7 :Find ・ F8 :Print out ・ F9 :Find/Replace ・ F10 :- Others - 2-11 Installation 3. INSTALLATION CAUTION To install this equipment, contact our service center or agents. Special knowledge on selecting the place where the antenna is to be mounted and setting the ID number (MMSI) assigned to the ship is required in addition to installing the equipment. 3-1 Operation 4. OPERATION This chapter describes basic operations of the controller and the data terminal, radiotelephone communications, telex communications, DSC calling procedures, and other radio functions. 4.1 4.1.1 Operation overview Operation of the controller Basically, the controller is operated with the numeric keypad (10key), the MENU key, and the jog dial for other than the telex communication. The following is an overview of their operation. When two controllers are connected, only one controller having the access right can operate the equipment except for sending a distress alert, changing audio volume, and changing display conditions. (Unless otherwise mentioned, the instructions below are for the controller with the access rights.) To obtain the access right at a controller without access rights, press ENT to get the access right unless the other controller is being operated (PTT/KEY ON or menu operations). The DISTRESS key is always available. (The DISTRESS key has the highest priority.) On the status display or the operating display, the communication frequency or channel can be set by using the number keys or if the transceiver setting screen is focused on, setting it by rotating the jog dial is also available. Pressing the TEL DSC or CW key changes the communication mode. If the screen displays in the menu, immediately shows the status display or the operating display, and also the channel input mode changes to the free frequency mode. Additionally, the communication mode can be changed to the AM mode to listen to the radio broadcasting or to the DATA mode to communicate using the intership fax When the communication mode is set to TEL or CW, pressing the same communication mode key turns the PA on and off. (When the PA is on, ON mark appears.) All functions can be accessed using the MENU key, jog dial, and the dedicated keys/controls. (See the menu tree on the next page.) Further, screens in the menu tree indicated by "Printable" can be printed from a printer connected to the controller or the data terminal by pressing and holding the F U N C key and then pressing the 7 P R N key. Pressing or pressing and holding the FUNC (function) key and a number key allows rapid access to that function. There are two ways to access main menu items. After pressing the MENU key to display the main menu, use either the jog dial to move the cursor to the desired item and press ENT to select it, or select the item by pressing the respective number key. (Ex: For Self diagnosis (6.1.1 Transceiver), press MENUÎ6 SP Î1 CLAR Î1 CLAR ) Any menu can be assigned to the USER key to open it with a single touch of a button. Normally the Pressing the CH key changes the channel input mode to the User ch, ITU ch or to the free frequency. This key is enabled when showing the status display or the operating display. Pressing the CANCEL key in any menu moves the display up one level in the hierarchy (or to the status display). The same results can be achieved by selecting "0. Back" when available on-screen. Further, pressing the CANCEL key on an input line will clear the entered data. P r e s s i n g t h e M E N U k e y i n a n y m e n u o p e n s t h e m a i n m e n u . A l s o , p r e s s i n g M E N U while in the main menu returns to the status display or the operating display. Dialog boxes (popup screens) are opened when necessary and operations can be done in the dialog box. When using DSC calls, to distinguish the messages or conditions, some specific alarms are provided as listed after the menu tree below. ANT TUNE key is always enabled. 4-1 Operation Menu tree Main Menu Hierarchical Menu 1 Hierarchical Menu 2 1. DSC non-distress call 2. DSC drobose call 3. Editing a distress msg 4. DSC logs 5. Radio operation 7. Setup Note MENU+3 4.1 Received distress (Received message screen) Printable 4.2 Received others (Received message screen) Printable 4.3 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 (Tran smit ted me s sag e s cre en) 5. 1 User channel list (table) 5.2 ITU channel list (table) Printable Printable Printable Transmitted calls User channel list (index) ITU channel list (index) Mode Receiver 5.5 Transmitter 6. Maintenance Shortcut Key MENU+1 ( R T N ) FUNC+0 ( Te s t ) MENU+2 6.1 Self diagnosis 6.2 Alarm information 6.3 Software ve rsion 7.1 Date & time 5.4.1 5.4.2 5.4.3 5.4.4 5.4.5 5.4.6 5.4.7 5.5.1 5.5.2 5.5.3 Auto gain control Noise reduction Attenuation Clarifier Squelch CW bandwidth Scan Power Tune power Auto tune start 6.1.1 Transceiver (ATU/PA/TRX /WKR MODEM) 6.1.2 Controller/DTE 6.1.3 Transceiver log 6.1.4 Controller/DTE log 6.1.5 DSC/NBDP loop 6.1.6 Printout Alarm history FUNC+5 FUNC+3 FUNC+4 FUNC+1 FUNC+2 FUNC+9 Printable FUNC+8 Printable Printable Printable Printable Printable Printable 7.1.1 Date 7.1.2 Present time 7.1.3 Display form 7.2 POS/TIME 7. 2.1 Own position 7.3 My controller 7. 3.1 LCD adjustment 1. Contrast 2. Dimmer 3. Screen saver 7.2.2 UTC of position 7.3.2 Sound 1. Operation 2. Notification leve l 3. Sidetone 7.3.3 User key assign FUNC+6 ( S P ) 7.3.4 Tx meter 7.3.5 Data transfer 7.3.6 Menu shutdown 7.3.7 CH search ref 7.4 User channels (index) 7.4 User channels (table) 7.5 DSC/W KR condition 7.5.1 Automatic ACK 1. Test call 2. Position RQ call 3. Polling call 4. Individual call 7.5.2 WKR scanning FRQ 7.5.3 DSC alarm setting 1. Safet y/ Rout in e R X ALM 2. Distress RX ALM 7.5.4 Medical use Printable 7.5.5 Neutral use 7.5.6 Group-ID 7.5.7 Inactivit y timeout 1. ACKed distress alert 2. RCVed other distress 3. Non-distress call 4. Other communications 7.5.8 DSC call list 7.6 Option 7.6.1 Connection 7.6.2 Data out 7.6.3 Baudrate 7.6.4 Flow control 7.6.5 Print direction 4-2 Printable Operation DSC alarm specifications The following table summarizes the alarm characteristics when communicating particularly in the DSC mode. Reason for the alarm Receiving a new distress event Sound Two tones of 2200Hz(250ms) and 1300Hz(250ms) Increase Yes Shutdow n Manually Acknowledging a received distress event Two tones of 2200Hz(500ms) and 1300Hz(500ms) No Manually Acknowledging a sent own distress event Two tones of 2200Hz(500ms) and 1300Hz(500ms) No Manually Receiving a new urgency event Intermittent tones of 2200Hz(250ms) and silence(250ms) Yes Manually Acknowledging a sent urgency event Intermittent tones of 2200Hz(500ms) and silence(500ms) No Manually Receiving a new safety or routine event Two tones of 784Hz(1s) and 392Hz(1s) Yes Automatically (10s) Acknowledging a sent safety or routine event Intermittent tones of 784Hz(1s) and silence(1s) No Automatically (10s) Receiving a DSC message pertinent to an ongoing event Intermittent tones of 494Hz(100ms), silence(100ms) and 494Hz(1s) An intermittent tone of 2000Hz(500ms) and silence(500ms) No Automatically (1 cycle) No --- Pressing the dedicated distress button Note If receiving a DSC message with the ECC error, the alarm is stopped automatically. However if the same DSC messages are received repeatedly and the every error is corrected at last, the original alarm may be sounded. 4-3 Operation 4.1.2 Operation of the data terminal Basically, the every function concerning the telex mode such as ARQ/FEC communication or scanning can be operated from the data terminal. ● To connect and install the data terminal, setup the 7.6 Option menu of the controller. ● To set the communicate mode to the telex mode, press the Enter key of the keyboard. Additionally, that operation acquires the access right if the controller connected to that data terminal does not have the access right. ● Every function of the data terminal can be operated from the main menu displayed on a regular screen, excluding the screen of communication modes other than the telex, telex communicating screen, the telex file editing screen. ● Because the short-cut key to the table of next page is allocated in each item of the main menu or the drop down menu, it is possible to execute it easily according to few procedures. ● The guide of the item shown with the cursor is basically displayed under the screen in the data terminal. ● While displaying the menu screen on the controller, the data terminal cannot be operated temporally. Similarly, the controller cannot be operated during the telex communication except the operations of TEL DSC CW and DISTRESS keys. ● Besides the telex communication in ARQ/FEC mode, the data terminal has other functions such as editing telex messages and the station list, setup of the radio condition, or setup of the display color of the screen. ● The communication using ARQ mode can be started with a specific radio station by inputting the selcal number (ID) and the work frequency. ● The communication using CFEC mode can be started as the broadcasting by inputting the work frequency. ● The communication using SFEC mode can be started as the broadcasting for limited receivers by inputting the selcal number (group ID) and work frequency. ● The telex communication channel can be set by specifying ARQ or FEC in the DSC message. In this case, the telex communication may be started without inputting 9 digits selcal number (ID) and work frequency because those have been already set by the DSC calling. ● Up to 20 stations can be registered in the station list. ● The self-diagnosis of the data terminal is executed from the controller as well as other units. ● The controller outputs the printing data from the printer connected to the data terminal. ● The condition of the data terminal such as the startup or the sleep is synchronized to the controller connected or the system. ● When the data terminal detects any error(s) concerning to the internal flash memory, the keyboard, the printer or the connected USB memory, immediately shows the popup screen and the Information is displayed on the bottom line on the screen until the error is fixed. 4-4 Operation Menu tree in data terminal Main Menu File Tune Connect Service System Help Short-cut Key Drop-do wn Ke y Edit new file Short-cut Key Edit existing file Rename file Delete file Cop y file Initialize USB Remo ve USB Frequency list ITU channel set Tx/Rx frequenc y set Tx tune Scanning start (stop) Remarks Printable ARQ CALL Option AUTOTELEX Option CFEC SFEC Call logging history Printable Station list Printable Station database Printable Destination list Option Sunspot number MUF calculation Clear status win dow Config Scan speed NBDP setup Software versio n 4-5 Operation 4.2 Basic communications procedure The following describes basic radio communication procedures. 4.2.1 Turning on the power CAUTION Do not turn off the equipment when at sea because the SOLAS Convention requires keeping watch on distress and safety frequencies at all times. Always listen to 2187.5 kHz and 8414.5 kHz, and one or more of the following frequencies; 4207.5 kHz, 6312.0 kHz, 12577.0 kHz, or 16804.5 kHz. In class B mode, it is necessary to keep watch only on 2187.5 kHz. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Make sure the equipment is connected to a power source and turn on the breakers on the power supply. ¾ The controller, transceiver and data terminal start the internal check. ¾ After the check is finished correctly, the status display appears and becomes receiving condition (standby) on the receiving frequency showing. Note When turning on the controller or the equipment in sleep mode, press PW R CONT key for one second. Pressing PW R CONT key for 6 seconds makes the system reset to restart. When two controllers are connected, and one controller is turned on from sleep mode, the status display is displayed immediately without checking operations. The start screen of the data terminal is as shown at right. If errors are detected during the operation check, the message is displayed. Please inform JRC or our agent of the error contents. 4-6 Operation 4.2.2 Turning off the power/ Putting into sleep mode CAUTION When completely turning off the power to the equipment, turn off the breakers on the power supply. ■ Procedure ■ Press the PW R CONT key and DIM key simultaneously. After that, the power-off process is activated according to the controllers' status. When using only one controller Select the desired item below on the popup screen shown at right ⋅ [OK]: Turns off the power. (Puts into sleep (energy saving) mode.) ⋅ [Cancel]: Returns to the previous screen. When using two controllers On a controller with access rights, select the desired item below on the popup screen shown at right ⋅ [EQP]: Turns off the power. (Puts into sleep (energy saving) mode.) ⋅ [CTRL]: Puts the controller into sleep mode and gives access rights to another controller. ⋅ [Cancel]: Returns to the previous screen. On a controller without access rights, select the desired item below on the displayed popup screen at right ⋅ [OK]: Puts one controller into sleep mode. ⋅ [Cancel]: Returns to the previous screen. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL ITU- 401 RX 4357.0 kHz TX 4065.0 kHz OK to sleep the MF/HF equipment? [ OK ] [Cancel] SIG NonDST: WKR scan bands: D R O B O S: 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz E d t D S T: ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL ITU- 401 RX 4357.0 kHz TX 4065.0 kHz OK to sleep the MF/HF equipment, or only this controller? SIG [EQP] [CTRL] [Cancel] NonDST: WKR scan bands: D R O BO S : 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz EdtDST: ¾ ¾ ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL ITU- 401 RX 4357.0 kHz TX 4065.0 kHz OK to sleep this controller? [ OK ] [Cancel] SIG NonDST: WKR scan bands: D R O BO S : 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz EdtDST: Note In sleep mode, the equipment changes to the following statuses. If all the equipment goes to sleep, the ALM lamp lights green to indicate the DSC watch keeping receiver is on and operating. ⋅ The POWER lamp of the data terminal blinks. ⋅ If a distress or urgent DSC message is received, the equipment turns on automatically and sounds an alarm. Turn off both the AC and DC breakers if turning off the power at the NBD-2250/2500 Power supply. ⋅ 4-7 Operation 4.2.3 Communicating in radiotelephone mode Use the handset to communicate in radiotelephone mode. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. When operating on a controller without access rights (OCC is displayed), press the jog dial to obtain the access rights. Unless the controller with access rights is being used, the access rights are acquired and the OCC display on the screen disappears. 22.. Press the TEL key. ¾ The communication mode is set to TEL and the previous frequency (or the default frequency at just after turning on) is set. ¾ Pressing the TEL key again turns the power to the PA on and off. ¾ If the power to the PA is on, ON is displayed as shown at right. 33.. Set the frequency for making calls in radiotelephone mode. Note When setting a frequency, the screen becomes operating display as shown at right. The frequency is set on the receiving status in the status display or the operating display. For details, see "4.3.1 Setting the communication frequencies" and "4.3.2 Setting the communication channels". See the frequency for making calls in the appendix "11.4 ITU channel list (TEL/CW/TLX)". 44.. Adjust the volume of the loudspeaker by turning the volume control. 55.. Turn the RF GAIN control to an appropriate reception level. 4-8 ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL ITU- 401 RX 4357.0 kHz TX 4065.0 kHz SIG NonDST: WKR scan bands: DROBOS: 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz EdtDST: ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL I T U - 4 0 2 4360.0 4068.0 Communicating on TEL Rx: 4360.0/Tx: 4068.0kHz Tip)Use FUNC to change op area. [HLD][END] Operation 66.. Press the Note ANT TUNE key to tune the antenna. T blinks if the transmission frequency is not tuned. Even if T is not displayed, tune the antenna before making a call. T lights during tuning. It goes out after tuning. 77.. Lift the handset from the cradle. 88.. Press the PTT key to talk. The TX and ON marks appear on the screen to show the equipment is transmitting. Releasing the PTT key returns it to receiving. Note Pressing the PTT key turns on the power to the PA automatically. 99.. When finished communicating, return the handset to the cradle. ■ Making a radiotelephone call ■ 11.. Set a frequency the station to be called is monitoring. 22.. Lift the handset from the cradle. 33.. Press the PTT key, check that TX and ON are displayed and make a call as described below. Say the name of the station being called ... Repeat 3 times. Say "This is..." Say own ship name ... Repeat 3 times. If necessary, indicate your working frequency. "over" 44.. Release the PTT key to listen. 55.. Start communicating according to the response. When changing frequencies, make sure that no other stations are using the indicated working channel. Note When transmitting from your own station, always press the PTT key while talking. On a simplex channel, always say "over" just before releasing the PTT key. Always say "out" when terminating communications. 4-9 Operation 4.2.4 Communicating in CW mode Use a CW keyer to communicate in CW mode. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. When operating on a controller without access rights (OCC is displayed), press the jog dial to obtain the access rights. Unless the controller with access rights is being used, the access rights are acquired and the OCC display on the screen disappears. 22.. Press the CW key. ¾ The communication mode is set to CW and the previous frequency (or the default frequency at just after turning on) is set. ¾ Pressing the CW key again turns the power to the PA on and off. ¾ If the power to the PA is on, ON is displayed as shown at right. 33.. Set the frequency for making calls in CW mode. Note - When setting a frequency, the screen becomes operating display as shown at right. The frequency is set on the receiving status in the status display. For details, see "4.3.1 Setting the communication frequencies" and "4.3.2 Setting the communication channels". See the frequency for making calls in the appendix "11.4 ITU channel list (TEL/CW/TLX)". 44.. Adjust the volume of the loudspeaker by turning the volume control. 55.. Turn the RF GAIN control to an appropriate reception level. 4-10 ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) CW ITU- 401 RX 4182.0 kHz TX 4182.0 kHz SIG NonDST: WKR scan bands: D R O B O S : 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz EdtDST: Operation 66.. Press the Note ANT TUNE key to tune the antenna. T blinks if the transmission frequency is not tuned. Even if T is not displayed, tune the antenna before making a call. T lights during tuning. It goes out after tuning. 77.. Communicate in CW mode using the CW keyer connected to the KEY jack on the controller as shown in the figure to the right. The TX and ON marks appear on the screen to show the equipment is transmitting. Note After keying on, turns on the PA power automatically. For the sidetone setting, see "5.3.2 Sound settings". 4-11 Operation 4.2.5 Receiving AM broadcasts It is possible to listen to the radio in AM mode. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. When operating on a controller without access rights (OCC is displayed), press the jog dial to obtain the access rights. Unless the controller with access rights is being used, the access rights are acquired and the OCC display on the screen disappears. 22.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select 5. Radio operation. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL Rx:13077.0/Tx:12230.0kHz 5)Radio operation 1.User channel list 2.ITU channel list 3.Mode :TEL 4.Receiver 5.Transmitter 0.Back 33.. Move the cursor to 3. Mode, and press ENT. Move the cursor to the right as shown in the figure at right to select a communication mode. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL Rx:13077.0/Tx:12230.0kHz 5)Radio operation 1.User channel list 2.ITU channel list 3.Mode :TEL 4.Receiver 5.Transmitter 0.Back 44.. Turn the jog dial to select AM, and press ENT. The communication mode is set to AM and the previous frequency (or the default frequency at just after turning on) is set. 55.. Press the MENU key twice to return to the status display and if required, input an AM broadcast frequency using the numeric keys. Then press ENT to receive the broadcast. Note Adjust the reception level and volume by turning the VOL and RF GAIN knobs according to the reception conditions. - The AM mode is for reception only so a transmission frequency is not shown. Additionally, if AM is selected during blinking “T” (ATU does not tuned), the condition remains even after changing to the AM mode. 4-12 Operation 4.2.6 Communicating in telex mode (TLX) When communicating in the telex mode, the data terminal is used. In the telex communication, the ARQ (Automatic Repeat reQuest) mode and FEC (Forward Error Correction) mode are available to communicate between two stations and to broadcast respectively. Additionally in the FEC mode, there are two modes of the CFEC (Collective Forward Error Correction) mode for unspecified receivers and SFEC (Selective Forward Error Correction) mode for specified receivers, which are selectable according to the purpose. Attention After starting the telex communication, always use the data terminal until to stop it even though the controller can terminate that communication with END option forcibly. 4.2.6.1 ARQ mode operation To start the ARQ communication, make a call of the station by inputting the SELCAL number (4 digits for the coast station, 5 digits for the ship station or 9 digits) and the work frequency. After initiating the call, when receiving the response from the called station and the communication channel is established, the ARQ communication will be available. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. If displaying the message of "Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode…" on the data terminal, press Enter key on the keyboard. The operation of the data terminal becomes possible in the telex mode, except when the controller is used. 22.. On the main menu and the dropdown menu, select Connect Î ARQ with Enter key. ¾ The registered station list is displayed. ¾ When selecting [Manual] on this station list, the ID and frequency or ITU channel can be input manually. 4-13 Operation 33.. Select the station to be called with the cursor, and press Enter key. ¾ The frequency list of the selected radio station is displayed. Name : [Station 01 ¾ If the position of the station is registered, the MUF (maximum usable frequency) is displayed in the lowest line as a reference to select the frequency. Also, the MUF can be calculated by the menu of Service Î MUF calculation. No. 10 Tx.F 4202.5 4205.0 6300.5 6303.0 8396.5 8399.0 12560.0 16785.0 18893.0 22352.0 Frequency list ] ID : [004310123] Loc : [N33゚45' E138゚12'] Rx.F 4202.5 4205.0 6300.5 6303.5 8396.5 8399.0 12560.0 16785.0 18893.0 22352.0 No. 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 Tx.F 22354.5 25193.0 25208.0 Rx.F 22354.5 25193.0 25208.0 [Set] [Print] [Cancel] MUF: 9MHz, Range: 2537Miles, Sunspot: 14 44.. Select the work frequency with the cursor, and press Enter key. ¾ The selected frequency is set and the antenna is tuned to the frequency. ¾ The message as shown at right is displayed to confirm that the channel is busy. 55.. Select Yes and press Enter key to start the call at the selected frequency. Calling of the station is started with the ARQ mode. [TLX] Tx= 2174.5kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz File Tune Connect S T -A BR YQ Free sig. Scanning info [No scanning] Calling USB Service STATUS INFO Send System Phasing Repeat Help Traf Tuner/Tx.POWER TUNER :[READY] Tx.POWER :[HIGH] Last status message ARQ: 20 AUG,2010 17:15 Station:[Station 01] ID:[004310123] Loc:[N33゚45'E138゚12'] *Waiting for transmitter ready *Received TX-READY signal F10 Stop 66.. When receiving the periodic reply from the called station and the communication channel is established, th e ARQ communication will be available. ¾ The screen as shown at right is displayed. ¾ If receiving no response within one minute, the calling will be ceased automatically. In this case, the same call is inhibited for about one minute. [TLX] Tx= 2174.5kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz Station ID:[004310123] Free sig. A RA QR Q USB TELEX Terminal Window Calling Rephasing Send Message start... F2 WRU | F3 Hereis | F4 TMS | F5 Over | F8 F.Send | F10 Stop 4-14 Repeat Traf Operation 77.. The characters typed with the keyboard can be transmitted in sequence. And all of the characters displayed on the screen are printed out on the printer. ¾ In the ARQ mode, it is possible to alternate the information sending station (ISS) and the information receiving station (IRS). ¾ While “Send” is displayed on the segment that shows the operation status, the own station is ISS and able to send a message. ¾ After sending a message, send “+?” to give the sending right to the IRS. [TLX] Tx= 2174.5kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz Station ID:[004310123] Free sig. USB TELEX Terminal Window Calling Rephasing Send A RA QR Q Repeat Traf Message start... THE THE THE THE END QUICK BROWN QUICK BROWN QUICK BROWN QUICK BROWN OF TEST FOX FOX FOX FOX JUMPS JUMPS JUMPS JUMPS OVER OVER OVER OVER THE THE THE THE LAZY LAZY LAZY LAZY DOG DOG DOG DOG 1234567890. 1234567890. 1234567890. 1234567890. F2 WRU | F3 Hereis | F4 TMS | F5 Over | F8 F.Send | F10 Stop ¾ While the condition is IRS, the sending right can be acquired by pressing F5 Over without waiting for “+?” from ISS. Further, refer to the chapter 2 for other function keys. ¾ Besides alphabets and the figures, following signs can be input from the keyboard. - ? : ( ) . , ‘ = / + Note: As the alphabets, capital letters only are available. 88.. To finish the communication, press F10 Stop key. ¾ When receiving the reply to the request for the end of communication, returns to the standby condition. ¾ F10 Stop is always available while communicating regardless of ISS/ IRS. Note that if pressing the F10 key during IRS condition, the station becomes ISS temporally to send the end of communication. ¾ When pressing the F10 Stop key during sending a message, the sending message buffer is cleared at once and initiates the end of communication process. ¾ When POLL is set at IRS and the end of communication is requested by ISS, the IRS can acquire the sending right without ending the communication. Note When receiving the ARQ call from another station during standby condition, the operation under the communication is basically similar. 4-15 Operation 4.2.6.2 CFEC mode operation ( 1 ) Sending with CFEC Messages can be sent as a broadcast on the selected work frequency using the CFEC mode. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. If displaying the message of "Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode…" on the data terminal, press Enter key on the keyboard. The operation of the data terminal becomes possible in the telex mode, except when the controller is used. [TEL] Tx= 2174.5kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz File Tune Connect USB Service System Help STATUS INFO Scanning info [No scanning] Tuner/Tx.POWER TUNER :[READY] Tx.POWER :[HIGH] Last status message Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode... 22.. On the main menu and the dropdown menu, select Connect Î CFEC with Enter key. ¾ Input the frequency or ITU channel on the screen as shown at right. ¾ To input the frequency, press Enter key to move the cursor to the right. ¾ To input the ITU channel, select the ITU channel button and press Enter key to display the specific screen as shown at right. Then press Enter key to move the cursor to the right. 33.. Input the work frequency or ITU channel, and press Enter key. ¾ The selected frequency is set and the antenna is tuned to the frequency. ¾ The message as shown at right is displayed to confirm that the channel is busy. 4-16 Operation 44.. Select Yes and press Enter key to start the call at the selected frequency. Sending the phasing signal is started with the CFEC mode. 55.. After sending the phasing signal for about 15 seconds, the message sending using the CFEC mode will be available. The screen as shown at right is displayed. 66.. The characters typed with the keyboard can be transmitted in sequence. And all of the characters displayed on the screen are printed out on the printer. ¾ Refer to the chapter 2 for the function key. ¾ Besides alphabets and the figures, following signs can be input from the keyboard. - ? : ( ) . , ‘ = / + Note: Only the capital letter can be used for the alphabet. 4-17 Operation 77.. To finish the communication, press F10 Stop key. ¾ After sending the end of communication for about five seconds, returns to the standby condition. ¾ When pressing the F10 Stop key during sending a message, the sending message buffer is cleared at once and initiates the end of communication process. [TLX] Tx= 2174.5kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz File Tune Connect S TS -T B- YB Y Free sig. Scanning info [No scanning] Calling USB Service STATUS INFO Receive System Rephasing Repeat Help Traf Tuner/Tx.POWER TUNER :[READY] Tx.POWER :[HIGH] Last status message CFEC: 20 AUG,2010 17:15 *Waiting for transmitter ready *Received TX-READY signal Move the cursor to the item you want with ↑, ↓, →, ← then press Enter. File manager. ( 2 ) Receiving CFEC broadcasting CFEC broadcasting messages can be received on the selected work frequency. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. If displaying the message of "Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode…" on the data terminal, press Enter key on the keyboard. The operation of the data terminal becomes possible in the telex mode, except when the controller is used. [TEL] Tx= 2174.5kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz File Tune Connect USB Service System Help STATUS INFO Scanning info [No scanning] Tuner/Tx.POWER TUNER :[READY] Tx.POWER :[HIGH] Last status message Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode... 22.. On the main menu and the dropdown menu, select Tune Î Tx/Rx frequency set with Enter key. ¾ The screen as shown at right is displayed. ¾ To input the frequency, press Enter key to move the cursor to the right. ¾ To select the frequency from the frequency list, select Tune Î Frequency list and open the frequency list of either one of radio stations. 4-18 Operation 33.. Input the receiving frequency of the CFEC broadcasting, and press Enter key. The antenna is tuned to the frequency and the message as shown at right is displayed. Note The transmitting frequency is set simultaneously by the above procedure, but in this case the frequency is meaningless. So selecting Yes and pressing Enter would be right. 44.. When receiving the phasing signal, initiates the CFEC receiving condition. The segment of the operation status shows receiving the phasing signal. 55.. When receiving the message start code (the carriage return and the line feed), initiates the message reception. ¾ All of the characters displayed on the screen are printed out on the printer. ¾ If detected the character error, the error correction with the time-diversity is performed, but upon the channel quality, the error would be beyond the capacity and the error code (asterisk) would be displayed. ¾ To finish the reception, press F10 Stop key. Note that, if receiving the phasing signal continuously, the CFEC receiving would be restarted just after finishing. Note If the "Collective FEC receiving” setting (System Î NBDP setup) is off, neither the CFEC broadcasting nor the SFEC broadcasting are received. Receiving the CFEC broadcasting can be started even if on the way of the message because the phasing signal would be interrupted for every 100 characters. Afterwards, the reception of the message starts as soon as detecting the message start code (the carriage return and the line feed). 4-19 Operation 4.2.6.3 SFEC mode operation Messages can be sent to the specific stations as a broadcast on the selected work frequency using the SFEC mode. Additionally, regarding the SFEC reception, refer to the previous section because it is similar to the CFEC reception. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. If displaying the message of "Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode…" on the data terminal, press Enter key on the keyboard. The operation of the data terminal becomes possible in the telex mode, except when the controller is used. [TEL] Tx= 2174.5kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz File Tune Connect USB Service System Help STATUS INFO Scanning info [No scanning] Tuner/Tx.POWER TUNER :[READY] Tx.POWER :[HIGH] Last status message Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode... 22.. On the main menu and the dropdown menu, select Connect Î SFEC with Enter key. ¾ The registered station list is displayed. ¾ When selecting [Manual] on this station list, the ID and frequency or ITU channel can be input manually. No. Station Name 1 Station 01 2 Station 02 3 Station 03 10 Station selection ID Location 004310123 N33゚45' E138゚12' 004311234 N37゚22' E135゚51' 431012345 33.. Select the station to be called with the cursor, and press Enter key. ¾ The frequency list of the selected radio station is displayed. ¾ If the position of the station is registered, the MUF (maximum usable frequency) is displayed in the lowest line as a reference to select the frequency. Also, the MUF can be calculated by the menu of Service Î MUF calculation. 4-20 F.Sig DOTDOT DOTDOT [Select] [Manual] [Cancel] ↓ Operation 44.. Select the work frequency with the cursor, and press Enter key. ¾ The selected frequency is set and the antenna is tuned to the frequency. ¾ The message as shown at right is displayed to confirm that the channel is busy. 55.. Select Yes and press Enter key to start the call at the selected frequency. ¾ The SFEC broadcasting is started. ¾ First, the phasing signal same with CFEC mode is sent. 66.. After sending the phasing signal followed by the SELCAL number, the message sending using the SFEC mode will be available. The screen as shown at right is displayed. [TLX] Tx= 2174.5kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz Station ID:[004310123] Free sig. AS RF QE C TELEX Terminal Window Calling Rephasing Send USB Repeat RQ Message start... F3 Hereis | F4 TMS | F8 F.Send | F10 Stop Note The following procedure is the same as the CFEC mode. 4-21 Operation 4.2.6.4 Editing telex messages When communicating in the telex mode, the message file can be sent, which is prepared beforehand as follows. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. If displaying the message of "Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode…" on the data terminal, press Enter key on the keyboard. The operation of the data terminal becomes possible in the telex mode, except when the controller is used. [TEL] Tx= 2174.5kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz File Tune USB Connect Service System Help STATUS INFO Scanning info [No scanning] Tuner/Tx.POWER TUNER :[READY] Tx.POWER :[HIGH] Last status message Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode... 22.. On the main menu and the dropdown menu, select File Î Edit new file with Enter key. ¾ The editing screen is displayed as shown at right. ¾ To edit an existing file, select File Î Edit existing file. [TLX] Tx= 2174.5kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz Editing telex file:001.TLX USB Line: 1 Column: 1 Size: 0 Insert On [End of File] F1:Insert Off F2:Ins_Line F7:Quit F3:Block F8:Save As F4:Del_Word F9:Save & Quit F5:Del_Line F10: - Others - 33.. Make the message with the keyboard. ¾ Besides alphabets and the figures, following signs can be input from the keyboard. - ? : ( ) . , ‘ = / + ¾ Only the capital letter can be used for the alphabet. ¾ When the number of characters for each line becomes more than 70 or a specified number, line feed is automatically inserted. ¾ When pressing the Tab key, inserts the space of the number set by F2 Set tab is inserted. 44.. Press F9 (Save & Quit) key when saving the message the file and finishing editing. After closing the editing screen, returns to the regular screen. 4-22 Operation Note ● The function keys available for the edit screen and the content are as follows. Group 1 ・ F1 : Insert On/Off ··············· ・ F2 ・ F3 : Ins_Line······················ : Block ·························· ・ F4 ・ F5 ・ F6 ・ F7 ・ F8 ・ F9 : Del_Word ···················· : Del_Line ····················· :( N/A) : Quit ···························· : Save As ······················ : Save & Quit ················ ・ F10 : - Others - ···················· ● Sets the input condition to the insert mode by pressing it while Insert On is displayed. And sets the input condition to the overwrite mode by pressing it while Insert Off is displayed. Current conditions are indicated on the upper-right corner of the screen. Add a line to the line of the cursor position. Indicates the following block menu. ・ Top-marker of block: Specifies the cursor position for a starting point of the block. ・ Bottom-marker of block: Specifies the cursor position for a ending point of the block. ・ Remove markers: Releases the specification of the block. ・ Copy Block: Copies and pastes the character string specified in the block onto the cursor position. ・ Move block: Moves the character string specified in the block to the line position of the cursor. ・ Delete block: Deletes the character string specified in the block. ・ Go to the block: Moves the cursor to the starting point of the block. Deletes the word at the cursor position. Deletes the line at the cursor position. Finishes editing without saving the message file. Saves the message file with the new name. Saves the message file by overwriting and finishes editing. Assigns the group 2 to the function keys. Group 2 ・ F1 ・ F2 ・ F3 : Max Column ················ : Set Tab ······················· : Undo_Char ·················· ・ F4 : Undo_Word ················· ・ F5 : Undo_Line ·················· ・ F6 : Merge File ·················· ・ F7 ・ F8 ・ F9 : Find ···························· : Print_out ····················· : Find/Replace ··············· ・ F10 : - Others - ···················· Specifies the column width of a line. Specifies the tab position on the edit screen. Insert the character erased at the end to the cursor position. Insert the word erased with F4 Del_Word to the cursor position. Insert the line erased with F5 Del_Line to the line of the cursor position. Selects an existing message file to merge to the message file under the edit. Searches a specified character string. Prints the message file under the edit. Searches a specified character string and replaces it with another character string. Assigns the group 1 to the function keys. 4-23 Operation Besides editing messages mentioned above, the following items in the file menu concerning to the message files are available. ・ Rename file ·········· Changes the name of the file saved in flash ROM(C:) or USB memory (A:) . ・ Delete file ············· Deletes the file saved in the flash ROM (C:) or the USB memory (A:) . ・ Copy file ··············· Copies a file (32kB or less) saved in the flash ROM (C:) or the USB memory (A:) to another folder or drive. ・ Initialize USB ········ Formats the attached USB memory (A:) . ・ Remove USB ········· Unmounts the USB drive (A:) to remove the attached USB memory. The maximum size of the message file is 8192 bytes. The maximum number of the message files saved in the TEXT folder is one hundred. When naming or renaming a filename, the space character is unavailable for the character string. 4-24 Operation 4.3 Setting the radio This section describes how to set the communication frequencies and how to use the receiver and transceiver functions. 4.3.1 Setting the communication frequencies Use the free frequency input mode to input the communication frequencies directly. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. In the status display, use the numeric keypad to input the frequency. Note When 1 is input using the numeric keypad, it appears on the far right as shown in the screen on the right. In the user/ITU channel input mode, press the CH key once or twice to hide the channel display. 22.. Input numbers to the 0.1 kHz place and press ENT. The transmission frequency input mode opens as shown in the screen at right. Note For a simplex frequency, press ENT to automatically input the same frequency as the receiving frequency to complete communication frequency settings. 33.. Input the transmission frequency in the same way as the reception frequency. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL -----.1 kHz TX 2331.5 kHz RX SIG NonDST: WKR scan bands: DROBOS: 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz EdtDST: ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 12345.0 kHz TX -----.- kHz RX SIG NonDST: WKR scan bands: DROBOS: 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz EdtDST: ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 12345.0 kHz TX ---12.3 kHz RX SIG NonDST: WKR scan bands: DROBOS: 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz EdtDST: 44.. Input numbers to the 0.1 kHz place and press ENT. The communication frequency settings are complete and the screen shows the operating display. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 12345.0 12345.0 Communicating on TEL Rx:12345.0/Tx:12345.0kHz Tip)Use FUNC to change op area. [HLD][END] Note Turning the jog dial on the status display changes the reception frequency on the 0.1 kHz scale. For simplex frequencies, the transmission frequency is changed at the same time. The above operation is also available on the transceiver setting screen of the operating display. The above operation is unavailable in the telex mode. The telex frequency is set with the menu of the data terminal, as Tune Î Tx/Rx frequency set. 4-25 Operation 4.3.2 Setting the communication channels Besides the free frequencies described previously, ITU channel mode and user channel modes can also be set. The ITU channel mode is mode for using channels based on the international standard and is built-in to the equipment. The user channel mode is the mode for using channels on pre-registered frequencies. These modes can be used according to the operations. (1) Selecting a frequency and channel input mode ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Set the screen of the status display or the operating display. The operating display at right shows free frequency mode. 22.. Press the CH key. As shown below, each time the CH key is pressed the mode changes in order from the free frequency mode, ITU channel mode, to the user channel mode. CH CH (Free frequency input mode) ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL I T U - 4 0 2 4360.0 4068.0 ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) CH TEL U 0 1 - 0 0 1 4357.0 4065.0 Communicating on TEL Rx: 4360.0/Tx: 4068.0kHz Communicating on TEL Rx: 4357.0/Tx: 4065.0kHz Tip)Use FUNC to change op area. [HLD][END] Tip)Use FUNC to change op area. [HLD][END] (ITU channel mode) Note 4-26 (User channel mode) If changed to the ITU channel mode, the communication mode of the free frequency input mode and the previous (or lowest) ITU channel number are applied. The above operation is unavailable in the telex mode. If the communication mode is changed by pressing the TEL, DSC, or CW keys, the free frequency input mode is set. Operation (2) Setting the ITU channels ■ Procedure ■ 11.. After setting the TEL, DSC or CW modes, press the CH key to set the display to the ITU channel mode. 22.. Input the channel by using the numeric keypad. Note When 4 is input using the numeric keypad, it appears on the far right as shown in the screen on the right. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL I T U - 4 4360.0 4068.0 Communicating on TEL Rx: 4360.0/Tx: 4068.0kHz Tip)Use FUNC to change op area. [HLD][END] 33.. Input the rest of the digits and press ENT. The input ITU channel frequency is displayed and the settings are complete. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL I T U - 4 0 1 4357.0 4065.0 Communicating on TEL Rx: 4357.0/Tx: 4065.0kHz Tip)Use FUNC to change op area. [HLD][END] Note See the appendix "11.4 ITU channel list (TEL/CW/TLX)" for a list of pre-installed ITU channels and their frequencies. Besides doing settings with the numeric keypad, settings can also be done with the jog dial. For DSC mode, normally perform the above procedure to receive the routine message. Furthermore, when sending a DSC message, the calling frequency is set via the menu automatically and the above procedure is not needed. The above operation is unavailable in the telex mode. The ITU channel in the telex mode is set with the controller menu 5.2 ITU channel list, or the data terminal menu operation, as Tune Î ITU channel set. 4-27 Operation (3) Setting user channels A total of 20 groups with 20 channels set to each group (i.e. 400 channels) can be registered on the equipment. This section explains how to set channels that are already registered. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Use the CH key to set the display to the user channel mode status display. 22.. Pressing ENT causes the channel group number to blink so a channel group can be input. Use the numeric keypad or jog dial to input the number of a registered group. Note When 2 is input using the numeric keypad, it appears on the far right as shown in the screen on the right. 33.. After inputting a group number, pressing ENT causes the channel number to blink so a user channel can be input. Use the numeric keypad or jog dial to input the number of a registered channel. Note When 3 is input using the numeric keypad, it appears on the far right as shown in the screen on the right. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL U 2 0 - 3 4357.0 4065.0 Communicating on TEL Rx: 4357.0/Tx: 4065.0kHz Tip)Use FUNC to change op area. [HLD][END] 44.. Input the rest of the digits and press ENT. ¾ The input user channel frequency is displayed and the settings are complete. ¾ The group name is displayed for 3 seconds after the settings are done. Note 4-28 Channels can be set directly in the status display or the operating display by using the numeric keypad or the jog dial without setting a channel group. After inputting with the numeric keypad, press ENT. See "5.4 Registering user channels" for how to register frequencies to user channels. The user channel of the telex mode is set with the menu of the data terminal, as Tune Î Frequency list. Operation (4) Using channel lists Besides the procedure above, user channels (except the telex mode) and ITU channels can also be set from the channel lists (5.1 User channel list or 5.2 ITU channel list). This section explains how to set channels that are already registered from the user channel list. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select 5. Radio operation. 5) Radio operation 1.User channel list 2.ITU channel list 3.Mode :TEL 4.Receiver 5.Transmitter 0.Back 22.. Select 1. User channel list and press ENT. The user channel list index (group list) as shown at right is displayed. 33.. Select the intended channel group and press ENT. The user channel list as shown at right is displayed. 5.1)User channel list (index) No CH group name Type 01 JRC Tokyo TEL 02 Pacific ABC CW 03 04 05 06 07 08 5.1)User channel list (table) Name: JRC Tokyo Type: TEL CHNo Rx[kHz] Tx[kHz] Mode 001 4357.0 4065.0 TEL 002 4360.0 4068.0 TEL 003 4363.0 4071.0 TEL 004 4366.0 4074.0 TEL 005 4369.0 4077.0 TEL 006 4372.0 4080.0 TEL 44.. Select the channel to set and press ENT. The user channel settings are complete, the status display is displayed. 4-29 Operation 4.3.3 Setting the automatic gain control (AGC) ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select 5.4 Receiver. 22.. Select 1. Auto gain control and press ENT, when the cursor moves to the right use the jog dial to select Slow, Fast, or OFF. After selecting and pressing ENT, the settings are complete. 5.4)Receiver 1.Auto gain control 2.Noise reduction 3.Attenuation 4.Clarifier 5.Squelch 6.CW bandwidth 7.Scan 0.Back :Slow :OFF :OFF :+000Hz :OFF :Narrow 5.4)Receiver 1.Auto gain control 2.Noise reduction 3.Attenuation 4.Clarifier 5.Squelch 6.CW bandwidth 7.Scan 0.Back :Fast :OFF :OFF :+000Hz :OFF :Narrow The same settings can be done by pressing and holding the FUNC key and the Note 5 AGC key at the same time. 4.3.4 Setting the noise reduction (NR) ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, after 5.4 Receiver appears, move the cursor to 2. Noise reduction. 22.. Press ENT to move the cursor to the right, then use the jog dial to select NR1, NR2, BC, or OFF. After selecting and pressing ENT, the settings are complete. Note 4-30 The various settings are shown below. ・ NR1: Noise reduction (low) ・ NR2: Noise reduction (high) ・ BC: Beat canceller The same settings can be done by pressing and holding the FUNC key and the 3 NR key at the same time. This function is invalid in DSC mode or telex mode. Moreover, the beat canceller becomes invalid in CW mode. 5.4)Receiver 1.Auto gain control 2.Noise reduction 3.Attenuation 4.Clarifier 5.Squelch 6.CW bandwidth 7.Scan 0.Back :Slow :OFF :OFF :+000Hz :OFF :Narrow 5.4)Receiver 1.Auto gain control 2.Noise reduction 3.Attenuation 4.Clarifier 5.Squelch 6.CW bandwidth 7.Scan 0.Back :Slow :NR1 :OFF :+000Hz :OFF :Narrow Operation 4.3.5 Setting the attenuation (ATT) ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, after 5.4 Receiver appears, move the cursor to 3. Attenuation. 22.. Press ENT to move the cursor to the right, then use the jog dial to select 6dB, 12dB, 18dB, or OFF. After selecting and pressing ENT, the settings are complete. 5.4)Receiver 1.Auto gain control 2.Noise reduction 3.Attenuation 4.Clarifier 5.Squelch 6.CW bandwidth 7.Scan 0.Back :Slow :OFF :OFF :+000Hz :OFF :Narrow 5.4)Receiver 1.Auto gain control 2.Noise reduction 3.Attenuation 4.Clarifier 5.Squelch 6.CW bandwidth 7.Scan 0.Back :Slow :OFF :6dB :+000Hz :OFF :Narrow The same settings can be done by pressing and holding the FUNC key and the Note 4 ATT key at the same time. 4.3.6 Setting the clarifier ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, after 5.4 Receiver appears, move the cursor to 4. Clarifier. 22.. Press ENT to move the cursor to the right, then use the jog dial or numeric keypad to select a value in the range of -200 to +200 Hz. After inputting and pressing ENT, the settings are complete. Note 5.4)Receiver 1.Auto gain control 2.Noise reduction 3.Attenuation 4.Clarifier 5.Squelch 6.CW bandwidth 7.Scan 0.Back :Slow :OFF :OFF :+000Hz :OFF :Narrow 5.4)Receiver 1.Auto gain control 2.Noise reduction 3.Attenuation 4.Clarifier 5.Squelch 6.CW bandwidth 7.Scan 0.Back :Slow :OFF :OFF :+008Hz :OFF :Narrow When using the numeric keypad, input "+" with the 1 CLAR key and "-" with the 2 S C AN key. Pressing and holding the FUNC key and the 1 CLA R key at the same time opens a popup screen. The same settings can be done here. This function is invalid in the DSC mode or the telex mode. 4-31 Operation 4.3.7 Setting the squelch level ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, after 5.4 Receiver appears, move the cursor to 5. Squelch. 22.. Press ENT to move the cursor to the right, then use the jog dial or numeric keypad to input a value in the range of 000 to 100. After inputting and pressing ENT, the settings are complete. Note 4.3.8 5.4)Receiver 1.Auto gain control 2.Noise reduction 3.Attenuation 4.Clarifier 5.Squelch 6.CW bandwidth 7.Scan 0.Back :Slow :OFF :OFF :+000Hz :OFF :Narrow 5.4)Receiver 1.Auto gain control 2.Noise reduction 3.Attenuation 4.Clarifier 5.Squelch 6.CW bandwidth 7.Scan 0.Back :Slow :OFF :OFF :+000Hz :012 :Narrow Setting the value to 000 automatically displays it as OFF. This function is invalid in the DSC mode or the telex mode. Setting the CW bandwidth ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, after 5.4 Receiver appears, move the cursor to 6. CW bandwidth. 22.. Press ENT to move the cursor to the right, then use the jog dial to select Wide or Narrow. After inputting and pressing ENT, the settings are complete. Note 4-32 This function is enabled in CW mode only. 5.4)Receiver 1.Auto gain control 2.Noise reduction 3.Attenuation 4.Clarifier 5.Squelch 6.CW bandwidth 7.Scan 0.Back :Slow :OFF :OFF :+000Hz :OFF :Narrow 5.4)Receiver 1.Auto gain control 2.Noise reduction 3.Attenuation 4.Clarifier 5.Squelch 6.CW bandwidth 7.Scan 0.Back :Slow :OFF :OFF :+000Hz :OFF :Narrow Operation 4.3.9 Scanning the Rx frequencies (1) Scanning of channels in TEL/DSC/CW mode The scanning of channels in the TEL/DSC/CW mode is started with the controller. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the 5.4)Receiver MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, after 5.4 Receiver appears, move the cursor to 7. Scan. 22.. Press ENT to confirm the selection. The group list as shown at right is displayed. Note The previous scan can be restarted by pressing and holding the FUNC key and then pressing the 2 SCAN key on the status display. If the user channel is not registered, scan cannot be done so the screen shown at right is not displayed. 33.. Select the channel group to scan with the cursor and press ENT. The popup screen as shown at right is displayed. Note If the popup screen shown at right is displayed during scanning, Stop appears instead of Execute. 44.. Select 1. Execute and press ENT, the screen at right is displayed and scanning starts. ¾ To check the registered channels in the channel group, select 2. User channel list and press ENT. ¾ To change the scanning speed, select 3. Scan speed (sec) and press ENT. The setting range is 0.3 to 9.9 seconds, the same as TEL/DSC/CW. Note 1.Auto gain control 2.Noise reduction 3.Attenuation 4.Clarifier 5.Squelch 6.CW bandwidth 7.Scan 0.Back 5.4.7)Scan No CH group name 01 JRC Tokyo 02 Pacific ABC 03 04 05 06 07 08 :Slow :OFF :OFF :+000Hz :OFF :Narrow Type TEL CW 5.4.7)Scan No CH group name Type 1. Execute 01 JRC Tokyochannel list TEL 2. User ABC 02 Pacific 3. Scan speed (sec) CW 03 04 TEL DSC CW 05 3.0 0.3 3.0 06 07 08 ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) JRC Tokyo U01- 001 TEL 4357.0 kHz TX -----.- kHz RX SIG NonDST: WKR scan bands: DROBOS: 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz EdtDST: Scanning can be done regardless of the squelch being set to open or close. When pressing the PTT or keying the CW keyer, or when squelch is opened after closing condition, scanning stops momentarily and the icon starts blinking. In this case the scanning can be restarted by pressing ENT. To stop scanning, press the CANCEL key. When scanning to receive routine DSC calls, set the scan speed to 0.3 seconds within 6 channels. Note: If too many channels are being scanned, it may not catch the reception. 4-33 Operation (2) Scanning of channels in telex mode The scanning of channels in the telex mode is started with the data terminal. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. If displaying the message of "Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode…" on the data terminal, press Enter key on the keyboard. The operation of the data terminal becomes possible in the telex mode, except when the controller is used. [TEL] Tx= 2174.5kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz File Tune USB Connect Service System Help STATUS INFO Scanning info [No scanning] Tuner/Tx.POWER TUNER :[READY] Tx.POWER :[HIGH] Last status message Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode... 22.. On the main menu and the dropdown menu, select Tune Î Scanning start with Enter key. The registered station list is displayed. 33.. Select the radio station having the channel group to be scanned with the cursor, and press Enter key. The antenna is tuned to the every frequency registered in the selected radio station. The screen at right is displayed while tuning the antenna. 44.. After completing the antenna tuning, scanning starts. ¾ The screen as shown at right is displayed while scanning. ¾ When receiving a call by the ARQ or FEC mode, scanning stops and the communication starts. After finishing the communication, scanning restarts automatically. ¾ The scanning speed can be changed with the menu on the regular screen, as System Î Scan speed. ¾ When breaking the scanning, select Tune Î Scanning stop. [TLX] Tx=-----.-kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz File Tune USB Connect Calling S TS -T B- YB Y Free sig. Scanning info No. Station:[Station 01 01 Location:[N33゚45'E138゚12'] Last status message Service STATUS INFO Receive Rephasing ID:[004310123] F.Sig:[DOTDOT] System Repeat Help Traf Tuner/Tx.POWER TUNER :[-----] Tx.POWER :[HIGH] Move the cursor to the item you want with ↑, ↓, →, ← then press Enter. File manager. 4-34 Operation 4.3.10 Reducing the Tx power ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through 5.5)Transmitter hierarchical menus, select 5.5 1.Power :High 2.Tune power :Normal 3.Auto tune start :ON Transmitter. 0.Back 22.. Select 1. Power and press ENT to move 5.5)Transmitter the cursor to the right, then use the jog dial to select Medium or Low. After selecting and pressing ENT, the settings are complete. Note 4.3.11 0.Back The same settings can be done by pressing and holding the FUNC key and the 9 PW RDC 1.Power :Low 2.Tune power :Normal 3.Auto tune start :ON key at the same time. When the Tx power is reduced, M or L is displayed on the screen. Setting the antenna tuning power ■ Procedure ■ On the 5.5 Transmitter menu mentioned above, select the 2. Tune power and press ENT to move the cursor to the right, then select a value from 0 to 3 with the jog dial. ¾ The antenna tune output grows larger by about 5W step. ¾ The factory default setting is 0 (Normal). ¾ After selecting and pressing ENT, the settings are complete. 4.3.12 Setting the Auto Tune Start (ATS) function ■ Procedure ■ On the 5.5 Transmitter menu mentioned above, select the 3. Auto tune start and press ENT to move the cursor to the right, then set to ON or OFF with the jog dial. ¾ After setting to ON, when pressing the PTT key under the following condition in TEL mode, the antenna tuner starts tuning automatically. When the Tx frequency is untuned, or when the PA power is not turned on, i.e. the ON is not displayed. ¾ This ATS setting data is saved in the controller. Therefore if two controllers are connected, this function can be set to the controllers respectively. 4-35 Operation 4.4 Basic DSC operations When calling stations, the DSC is also available for a routine, safety, urgency call, or a distress alert. This section describes basics of how to use the DSC to make routine calls. 4.4.1 Routine calls to an individual station For radiotelephone or telex communication, a DSC routine call to the station to be called can be made as follows. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. On the status display or operation display, holding down the MENU key, press 1 CLAR key to open “1. DSC non-distress call”. The screen as shown at right is displayed. The calling FRQ of 2177.0 kHz is the prescribed default value. But the working FRQ (MF) is rewritable. Note [Call] [Preview] [Cancel] If no data is shown in the working FRQ field just after turning on, please contact JRC or our agency to register the nonvolatile data. In this case, the input MF data is stored temporarily as the volatile data. 22.. Input the destination address. - If inputting the 9 digits MMSI manually, use the numeric keypad or the jog dial, or - If the DSC call list is already prepared, press ENT to open the station list as shown at right and select the receiver from the list. 33.. The cursor is focused on the Call. To make a call without changing the parameters, press ENT. - To change the DSC calling frequency, select the Calling FRQ and press ENT to open the DSC call list as shown at right, if already prepared. But in this case if inputting manually, press CANCEL key to close the list and, input the proper DSC frequencies in conformity with regulations. - After changing the DSC calling frequency on HF, the working frequency is automatically selected within upto 10 seconds. However if no frequency is detected or if another frequency is needed, manually inputting the frequency is also available. - To check the details of the message, press ENT on the Preview menu to open the screen as shown at right (bottom). 4-36 1)DSC non-distress call Call type :[RTN/Indv/TEL Address :[ Calling FRQ:[ 2177.0kHz] Working FRQ:[ 2150.0kHz] 1)DSC non-distress call Call type :[RTN/Indv/TEL ] No Station name MMSI 01 JRC MITAKA1 123456789 02 JRC MITAKA2 431012345 03 JRC MITAKA3 431123456 04 JRC MITAKA4 431234567 05 JRC MITAKA5 431000123 06 JRC MITAKA6 004310014 07 JRC MITAKA7 431888888 1)DSC non-distress call Call type :[RTN/Indv/TEL Address :[123456789] Calling FRQ:[ 2177.0kHz] Working FRQ:[ 2150.0kHz] [Call] [Preview] [Cancel] 1)DSC non-distress call Call type :[RTN/Indv/TEL ] JRC MITAKA1 123456789 No RX[kHz] TX[kHz] Category 01 2177.0 2177.0 RTN 02 4208.0 4208.0 RTN 03 4208.5 4208.5 RTN 04 4209.0 4209.0 RTN 05 6313.0 6313.0 RTN 06 6313.5 6313.5 RTN 1)DSC non-distress call Format :Individual Address :123456789 Category :Routine Self-ID :431001234 Telecommand1:Radiotelephone Telecommand2:No information Working FRQ :Tx 2150.0kHz Rx 2150.0kHz [Call] [Return] [Cancel] Operation 44.. The operating display is appeared and ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) initiates the DSC call. After checking the channel free condition, sends the message and waits for the acknowledgement. Note During waiting for the acknowledgement, the handling menus are available for the following purposes. Note) To focus the cursor on it, use FUNC key to move the active screen area. DSC 2177.0 2177.0 TxTO:123456789|IND|RTN Waiting for CH free Call-F:Rx 2177.0/Tx 2177.0kHz TEL :Rx 2150.0/Rx 2150.0kHz [RTRY][INF][HLD][END] - RTRY ... Resends the message. - INF ...... Indicates the message contents. - HLD ..... Makes the event on hold. - END .... Terminates the event. 55.. When receiving the acknowledgement the ALM lamp starts blinking, and the receiving alarm gradually grows louder. ¾ Pressing CANCEL key or ENT silences the alarm. ¾ The radiotelephone frequency is set and the antenna is tuned automatically. 66.. When requested the radiotelephone communication, start the communication with the handset. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) DSC 2177.0 2177.0 RxID:123456789|IND|RTN|ACK Acknowledged(00.2min) Rx FRQ: 2177.0kHz TEL :Rx 2150.0/Tx 2150.0kHz Press CANCEL to silence alarm. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 2150.0 2150.0 RxID:123456789|IND|RTN|ACK Ready to talk(00.2min) RX FRQ: 2177.0kHz TEL :Rx 2150.0/Tx 2150.0kHz [INF][HLD][END] Note After completing the routine individual call where the ARQ or FEC is specified, the telex mode is set to the equipment. Then the telex communication can be started with the data terminal. If the MMSI of the coast station is input at Address, the working frequency is specified by the coast station. Thus the Working FRQ line is disappeared. If the receiver is unable to comply with the call, own station may receive one of the following acknowledgements. (* are coast stations only) In this case, wait and retry the call again later, if possible, according to the message. No reason/ No reason given No operator/ No operator available Congestion/ Congestion at maritime switching centre * Temp no operator/ Operator temporarily unavailable Busy/ Busy EQP disabled/ Equipment disabled Queue/ Queue indication Unable FRQ/ Unable to use proposed channel Barred/ Station barred Unable mode/ Unable to use proposed channel 4-37 Operation 4.4.2 Receiving routine individual calls When receiving an individual DSC call from a coast or ship station, according to the message, perform the following procedures as appropriate. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. The screen at right is displayed, and the ALM lamp blinks and the alarm grows louder gradually. ¾ The example message contains the following information. - Message type: Routine individual call - Caller's MMSI: 123456789 ¾ If no procedure exists, starts operating the received message automatically. 22.. Press the CANCEL key or ENT to stop the alarm, then the screen at right is displayed. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) DSC 2177.0 2177.0 RxID:123456789|IND|RTN Waiting to send ACK(00.3min) RX FRQ: 2177.0kHz TEL :Rx 2150.0/Tx 2150.0kHz Press CANCEL to silence alarm. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) DSC 2177.0 2177.0 RxID:123456789|IND|RTN Waiting to send ACK(00.3min) RX FRQ: 2177.0kHz TEL :Rx 2150.0/Tx 2150.0kHz [ACK][NCK][NEW][INF][HLD][END] 33.. Press FUNC key or ENT to move the focused screen to the operation control screen and select the option to handle the procedure. Options shown at right are as follows. ACK ....... Sends the acknowledgement. NCK Sends a reply as “unable to comply”. Note) Select the unable reason on the ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) DSC 2177.0 2177.0 RxID:123456789|IND|RTN Waiting to send ACK(00.3min) RX FRQ: 2177.0kHz TEL :Rx 2150.0/Tx 2150.0kHz [ACK][NCK][NEW][INF][HLD][END] popup screen at right. NEW ...... Sends acknowledgement with a new channel. INF ........ Indicates the receiving message. HLD ....... Makes the procedure on hold. END ...... Terminates the procedure. 44.. When sending the acknowledgement for communication, select ACK and press ENT. ¾ Instead of selecting ACK, lifting the handset from the cradle is also available. ¾ The equipment waits for the channel free condition as shown at right. After checking it, the acknowledgement is sent immediately. 4-38 ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) DSC 2177.0 2177.0 TxTO:123456789|IND|RTN|ACK Waiting for CH free Call-F:Rx 2177.0/Tx 2177.0kHz TEL :Rx 2150.0/Tx 2150.0kHz [RTRY][INF][HLD][END] Operation 55.. After sending an acknowledgement, the working frequency is set to communicate. In TEL mode, start communicating using the handset. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 2150.0 2150.0 TxTO:123456789|IND|RTN|ACK Acknowledged(00.5min) Call-F:Rx 2177.0/Tx 2177.0kHz TEL :Rx 2150.0/Tx 2150.0kHz [RTRY][INF][HLD][END] Note After completing the DSC call sequence specifying the ARQ or FEC, the telex mode is set to the equipment. Then the telex communication can be started with the data terminal. If the receiving call is not the above mentioned call which requests TEL or TLX communication but a polling call, the screen as follows is shown and, the ALM lamp blinks and the alarm grows louder gradually. In this case, after silencing the alarm, select ACK to acknowledge it. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) DSC 2177.0 2189.5 RxID:001234567|IND|RTN POLL Waiting to send ACK(00.5min) RX FRQ: 2177.0kHz [ACK][INF][HLD][END] Additionally note that if it is received while the 7.5.1.3 Polling call of the Automatic ACK menu is set to ON, and there is no active procedure, this call can be acknowledged automatically. 4-39 Operation 4.4.3 Routine group calls For radiotelephone or FEC broadcasting, a DSC routine call to a group of ships is available. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. On the menu “1. DSC non-distress call” mentioned above, set the Call type on the menu shown at right to RTN/Group/TEL or RTN/Group/FEC. 1)DSC non-distress call Call type :[RTN/Group/TEL ] Address :[ Calling FRQ:[ 2177.0kHz] Working FRQ:[ 2150.0kHz] [Call] 22.. Input the Address, and frequency if required. And then press ENT on the Call to start sending the group call. frequency is set immediately. In TEL mode, start broadcasting using the handset. [Cancel] 1)DSC non-distress call Call type :[RTN/Group/TEL ] Address :[012345678] Calling FRQ:[ 2177.0kHz] Working FRQ:[ 2150.0kHz] [Call] 33.. After finishing the transmission, the working [Preview] [Preview] [Cancel] ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 2150.0 2150.0 TxTO:012345678|GRP|RTN Ready for broadcast(00.5min) Call-F:Rx 2177.0/Tx 2177.0kHz TEL :Rx -----.-/Tx 2150.0kHz [RTRY][INF][HLD][END] Note 4.4.4 After completing the group call where the FEC is specified, the telex mode is set to the equipment. Then the telex communication can be started with the data terminal. Receiving routine group calls ■ Procedure ■ The screen at right is displayed, and the ALM lamp blinks and the alarm grows louder gradually. If no procedure exists, starts operating the received message, i.e. the specified working frequency is set automatically. Then press CANCEL to silence alarm and listen to the broadcasting. Note 4-40 ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 2150.0 2150.0 RxID:123456789|GRP|RTN Ready for listening(00.5min) RX FRQ: 2177.0kHz TEL :RX 2150.0/TX -----.-kHz [INF][HLD][END] When receiving the group call where the FEC is specified, the telex mode is set to the equipment. Then receive the telex broadcasting with the data terminal. Operation 4.5 Emergency calls (DSC distress/urgency/safety calls) In emergency, the DSC is available for distress, urgency, or safety calls. For safety and urgency calls, either individual calls or area calls is selectable for the type of call. For distress alerts, either sending after entering the nature of distress or frequency, or not entering anything is available. In both cases, pressing the DISTRESS key is required to send the distress alert. 4.5.1 Safety or urgency calls to an individual station ■ Procedure ■ The procedure to send the safety or urgency individual call is similar to the routine call except selecting the call type to SAF/Indv/TEL or 1)DSC non-distress call Call type :[SAF/Indv/TEL Address :[ Calling FRQ:[ 2187.5kHz] Working FRQ:[ 2182.0kHz] URG/Indv/TEL (instead of TEL, ARQ or FEC also available) and normally using the distress and safety frequencies prior to other frequencies. Note 4.5.1.1 (1) [Call] [Preview] [Cancel] - Both calls of the safety test and the safety position request are described below. - When calling a coast station with requesting the working frequency, input “0” in the Tx and Rx frequency input field to send the own position data. Special safety individual calls Safety test calls ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Select SAF/Indv/Test in the Call type field and input address. 1)DSC non-distress call Call type :[SAF/Indv/Test ] Address :[ Calling FRQ:[ 2187.5kHz] Also change the Calling FRQ if needed. [Call] 22.. Press ENT on the Call to start sending the safety test call. After checking the channel free, the safety test call is sent and the screen at right is displayed. [Preview] [Cancel] ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) DSC 2187.5 2187.5 TxTO:123456789|IND|SAF Test Waiting for ACK(00.2min) Call-F:Rx 2187.5/Tx 2187.5kHz [RTRY][INF][HLD][END] 4-41 Operation 33.. When the acknowledgement is received, the ALM lamp blinks and the alarm grows louder. After silencing it with CANCEL key, the screen becomes as shown at right. The safety test call process is now complete. However note that even though the call is sent normally, the acknowledgement may not be received from the called station for some reason. (2) ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) DSC 2187.5 2187.5 RxID:123456789|IND|SAF Test|ACK Acknowledged(00.2min) RX FRQ: 2187.5kHz [INF][HLD][END] Safety position request calls ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Select SAF/Indv/PosRQ in the Call type field and input address. 1)DSC non-distress call Call type :[SAF/Indv/PosRQ] Address :[ Calling FRQ:[ 2187.5kHz] Also change the Calling FRQ if needed. [Call] 22.. Press ENT on the Call to start sending the safety position request call. After checking the channel free, the safety position request call is sent and the screen at right is displayed. [Preview] [Cancel] ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) DSC 2187.5 2187.5 TxTO:123456789|IND|SAF POS Waiting for ACK(00.2min) Call-F:Rx 2187.5/Tx 2187.5kHz [RTRY][INF][HLD][END] 33.. When the acknowledgement is received, the ALM lamp blinks and the alarm grows louder. After silencing it with CANCEL key, the screen becomes as shown at right. The position data of the station is indicated in the Position field usually, and this procedure is complete. However note that even though the call is sent normally, the acknowledgement may not be received from the called station for some reason. 4-42 ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) DSC 2187.5 2187.5 RxID:123456789|IND|SAF POS|ACK Acknowledged(00.2min) RX FRQ: 2187.5kHz Position:21゚28'N/157゚59'W [INF][HLD][END] Operation 4.5.2 Receiving safety or urgency individual calls When receiving an individual DSC call from a coast or ship station, according to the message, perform the following procedures as appropriate. ■ Procedure ■ The screen at right is displayed, and the ALM lamp blinks and the alarm grows louder gradually. ¾ If no procedure exists, starts operating the received message automatically. ¾ Basically similar to the routine individual call except normally using the distress and safety frequencies prior to other frequencies. 4.5.2.1 (1) ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 2182.0 2182.0 RxID:123456789|IND|SAF Waiting to send ACK(00.3min) RX FRQ: 2187.5kHz TEL :Rx 2182.0/Tx 2182.0kHz Press CANCEL to silence alarm. Receiving special safety individual calls Safety test calls ■ Procedure ■ The screen at right is displayed, and the ALM lamp blinks and the alarm grows louder gradually. ¾ If received while the 7.5.1.1 Test call of the Automatic ACK menu is set to ON and there is no active procedure, this call can be acknowledged automatically. ¾ To acknowledge manually, after silencing the alarm with CANCEL key, select ACK to start sending procedure. (2) ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) DSC 2187.5 2187.5 RxID:123456789|IND|SAF Test Waiting to send ACK(00.2min) RX FRQ: 2187.5kHz [ACK][INF][HLD][END] Safety position request calls ■ Procedure ■ The screen at right is displayed, and the ALM lamp blinks and the alarm grows louder gradually. ¾ If received while the 7.5.1.2 Position RQ call of the Automatic ACK menu is set to ON and there is no active procedure, this call can be acknowledged automatically. ¾ To acknowledge manually, after silencing the alarm with CANCEL key, select ACK to start sending procedure. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) DSC 2187.5 2187.5 RxID:123456789|IND|SAF POS Waiting to send ACK(00.2min) RX FRQ: 2187.5kHz [ACK][NCK][INF][HLD][END] ¾ When sending a reply as “unable to comply”, select NCK to send the acknowledge with no position data. 4-43 Operation 4.5.3 Safety or urgency area calls For radiotelephone or FEC broadcasting, a DSC safety area call can be made as follows. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. On the menu 1.DSC non-distress call, set the Call type to SAF/Area/TEL or URG/Area/TEL (instead of TEL, FEC also available). The menu becomes as shown at right and the cursor moves to the Area form. 1)DSC non-distress call Call type :[SAF/Area/TEL Area form :[Center&rad] - Center :[89゚N179゚E] - Radius :[0500NM] Calling FRQ:[ 2187.5kHz] Working FRQ:[ 2182.0kHz] [Call] 22.. Set the area to call. Input as below according to the Area form settings. - When Center&rad ・ Enter the center point of the area in Center. [Preview] [Cancel] 1)DSC non-distress call Call type :[SAF/Area/TEL Area form :[Corner&dev] - Corner :[ ゚N ゚E] - Deviation:[ ゚/ ゚] Calling FRQ:[ 2187.5kHz] Working FRQ:[ 2182.0kHz] ・ Enter the radius of the area in Radius. - When Corner&dev (shown at right) [Call] [Preview] [Cancel] ・ Enter the northwest corner of the area in Corner. ・ Enter the south and north/east and west deviation in a range from 00 to 99 in Deviation. 33.. Select the Working FRQ/ Calling FRQ if needed, then press ENT to start the area call. 44.. After finishing the transmission, start the communication with the handset in TEL mode. Note ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) DSC 2187.5 2187.5 TxTO:Area|SAF Waiting for CH free Call-F:Rx 2187.5/Tx 2187.5kHz TEL :Rx -----.-/Tx 2182.0kHz [RTRY][INF][HLD][END] Incase of the urgency call, to inform receivers of the particular topic, additional settings such as Medical TRNSP (medical transport ship) or Neutral ship (neutral nationality) in the Subject field as shown at right are available. However to use this function, it is needed to set the menu 7.5.4 Medical use or 7.5.5 Neutral use to ON once after powering on the equipment. 1)DSC non-distress call Call type :[URG/Area/TEL ] Area form :[Center&rad] - Center :[89゚N179゚E] - Radius :[0500NM] Subject :[No information] Working FRQ:[ 2182.0kHz] Calling FRQ:[ 2187.5kHz] [Call] 4-44 [Preview] [Cancel] After finishing the area call where the FEC is specified, the telex mode is set to the equipment. Then start the telex communication with the data terminal. Operation 4.5.4 Receiving safety or urgency area calls ■ Procedure ■ The screen at right is displayed, and the ALM lamp blinks and the alarm grows louder gradually. If no procedure exists, starts operating the received message, i.e. the specified working frequency is set automatically. Then press CANCEL to silence alarm and listen to the broadcasting. Note ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 2182.0 2182.0 RxID:123456789|Area|SAF Ready for listening(00.2min) RX FRQ: 2187.5kHz TEL :Rx 2182.0/Tx -----.-kHz [INF][HLD][END] When receiving the area call where the FEC is specified, the telex mode is set to the equipment. Then receive the telex broadcasting with the data terminal. To check the topic when receiving an urgency area call, select INF menu to view the detail of the message. 4-45 Operation 4.5.5 Distress alerts When in distress, distress alerts are always transmitted by pressing the dedicated DISTRESS key. The distress alerts transmit your own MMSI, ships position, time of the position, and the nature of distress. CAUTION Do not test the distress alert. Doing so may inconvenience local shipping and rescue centers. When sending a distress alert, follow the instructions of the ship's captain or officer in charge. If a false distress alert is transmitted accidentally, select the Cancel menu and transmit the distress cancel referring the guidance displayed on the controller. And then report the false distress alert to a nearby RCC (Rescue Coordination Center/ in Japan, inform the nearest Japan Coast Guard.) Information to be reported: Ship's name, type, nationality, and ID number, the date/time, location and reason why the false distress alert was transmitted. Also the unit model name and manufacture number/date, if possible. 4.5.5.1 Quick distress alerts The following describes the procedure to send a distress alert immediately without using menus. In this case, the nature of distress in the message will be sent as "Undesignated" by default. Further, if no information for the position and the time of position obtained within 23.5 hours, this information will be composed automatically. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Open the DISTRESS key cover. 22.. Press and hold the DISTRESS key for 4 seconds until the countdown is completed. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL ITU- 401 RX 4357.0 kHz TX 4065.0 kHz Distress call starts SIG in sec NonDST: WKR scan bands: DROBOS: 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz EdtDST: 4-46 Operation 33.. After the antenna is tuned, the distress alert is sent. The distress alerts are sent on all 6 distress and safety frequencies. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) DSC Rx: 2187.5/Tx: 2187.5kHz Distress calling Next :--Stage :Waiting for CH free Call-F: / / / / / Nature:Undesignated PosUTC: 89゚59.0123'N :179゚59.6789'E @23:59 Mode :Radiotelephone [Cancel] SIG WKR 44.. The equipment stays in distress mode until acknowledgement is received or the distress alert cancelling procedure is complete. ¾ Unless an acknowledgement is received or the distress alert is cancelled manually, the distress alert repeats automatically in a variable interval every 3.5 to 4.5 minutes. (The time until next sending is shown at Next.) 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) TEL Rx: 8291.0/Tx: 8291.0kHz Distress calling Next :Resends 4.1min later Stage :Waiting for ACK Call-F:2/4/6/8/12/16 Nature:Undesignated PosUTC: 89゚59.0123'N :179゚59.6789'E @23:59 Mode :Radiotelephone [FRQ][Pause][POS][CHNG][Cancel] SIG WKR 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz ¾ The distress alert can be sent manually while waiting for acknowledgement by the DISTRESS key operation mentioned above. ¾ While waiting for the acknowledgement, the radiotelephone communication is available. Additionally, when focusing the frequencies as shown at right, the distress and safety frequency can be changed with the jog dial. ¾ Pressing CANCEL key or ENT moves the focused screen and makes following options available. FRQ ......... Moves the cursor to the frequency section Pause ...... Makes the distress mode pause. POS ......... Opens the position input menu CHNG ...... Changes the distress alert type (Multi/Single mode and the frequencies) Cancel ..... Starts the distress alert cancelling procedure, which is needed to send the DSC acknowledgement and to broadcast in the radiotelephone mode from the “own ship”. Furthermore, if the POS/CHNG is edited, MEM icon is displayed to indicate that there are some data stored temporarily until resending the distress alert. 55.. When the acknowledgement is received, the message is displayed as shown at the right. ¾ The ALM lamp starts blinking, and the receiving alarm gradually grows louder. ¾ The radiotelephone mode is set to the distress/safety frequency of the band on which the acknowledgement is received and antenna tuning is done immediately. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 2182.0 2182.0 DST ALT RxID:123456789|OWN D-ACK|2MHz DIST acknowledged(00.2min) T x : 2|4|6|8|12|16/ U n d e s i g n a t e d / T E L 89゚59.0123'N179゚59.6789'E@23:59 Press CANCEL to silence alarm. ¾ Press the CANCEL key or ENT to silence the alarm, then call for help with the handset. Normally, the responding station calls on the radiotelephone. Then reply to the receipt as follows. Say, "MAYDAY". Say, "This is". Own ship's MMSI and call sign, position, nature of distress, and rescue requests 4-47 Operation Note If cancelling the distress alert since a false distress alert is transmitted accidentally, perform the distress alert cancelling procedure as follows. 1. Press the CANCEL key while the option selectable screen is focused. 2. On the popup screen, select Continue with the jog dial, and press ENT. Starts the distress alert cancelling procedure and sends the DSC acknowledgements to own ship in every frequency where distress alerts are transmitted. 3. After DSC acknowledgements are complete, the popup screen is displayed as shown at right. If the false distress alert indicates the FEC mode, the popup screen is displayed as shown at lower right. In this case, the message for cancelling distress alert is sent in the TLX mode automatically without operating the DTE. 4. According to the guidance on the screen, broadcast to cancel the distress alert in TEL mode. ¾ When finishing the broadcast on a frequency, press ENT to change to the next frequency. ¾ The cancelled frequency shows ✓ mark. 5. When the cancelling procedure is completed on every frequency, displays the operating screen as shown at right and finishes the distress mode. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) TEL Rx: 8291.0/Tx: 8291.0kHz Distress calling Next :Resends 3.8min later Stage :Waiting for ACK C a l l - F : 2 !/ !4 W/ a6 r/ n8 i/ n1 g2 !/ !1 6 Nature:Undesignated P o s CU aT nC c: e l8 9 t゚ h5 e9 . t0 r1 a2 n3 s' mN i t t e d f a l s: e1 7 d9 i゚ s5 t9 r. e6 s7 s8 9 a' lE e r@ t2 ?3 : 5 9 M o d (e T G T: :R a 2d /i 4o /t 6e /l 8e /p 1h 2o /n 1e 6 M ) [Continue] [Return] [FRQ][Pause][POS][CHNG][Cancel] SIG WKR 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) DSC Rx: 2187.5/Tx: 2187.5kHz Distress cancel calling Stage :Waiting for CH free Call-F: / / / / / Nature:Undesignated PosUTC: 89゚59.0123'N :179゚59.6789'E @23:59 Mode :Radiotelephone SIG WKR 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) TEL Rx: 2182.0/Tx: 2182.0kHz Cancelling the distress alert Voice cancellation procedure: All stations. (three times) T h i sD SiCs c[aNnAcMeEl]l[iCnAgL Lc aSlIlGsN ] a r e c[oMmMpSlIe]t[ePdO.S &NUeTxCt],. C a nsctealr tm yt hdei svtoriecses caalnecretl o f o n t h e[ DrAeTqEu]i[rUeTdC ]b.a n d s Over. according to the T a r gmeets:s a2g/e 4o/n 6t/h e8 /s c1r2e/e n1.6 M H z *To change the band, press ENT. [[ OOKK ]] SIG WKR 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) TEL Rx: 4125.0/Tx: 4125.0kHz Cancelling the distress alert Voice cancellation procedure: All stations. (three times) This is [NAME][CALL SIGN] [MMSI][POS&UTC]. Cancel my distress alert of [DATE][UTC]. Over. Target: 2/ 4/ 6/ 8/ 12/ 16MHz *To change the band, press ENT. SIG WKR 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 2182.0 2182.0 TxTO:All|DST|ACK Cancelled DISTRESS (00.2min) Call-F:2/4/6/8/12/16 [RTRY][INF][FRQ][HLD][END] 4-48 Operation 4.5.5.2 Distress alerts from the menu Attention During communicating in telex mode, finish it to enable the menu before practicing below. The following describes the procedure to send a distress alert with the nature of distress selected in the menu. Also, besides manually inputting position and the time information, the subsequent communication mode, the transmission method and frequency can be set here. Note: Multi-frequency or single frequency can be selected as the transmission method. The various methods are shown below. ⋅ ⋅ Multi-frequency method: The distress alert message is sent continuously on each frequency, 2187.5 kHz, 8414.5 kHz, and at least one other distress/safety frequency. Single frequency method: The same distress alert message is sent on one distress/safety frequency 5 times continuously. If 2 or more distress/safety frequencies are selected, the same message is transmitted 5 times continuously in the same way on the other frequency after an interval between 3.5 to 4.5 minutes (variable). ■ Procedure ■ 11.. On the status display or operation display, while pressing and holding MENU key, press 3 NR key to open “3. Editing a distress msg”. The distress type is displayed as Undesignated as a default value. If the position information is input automatically by a GPS type device, or has already input manually, that information is also displayed. 22.. Press ENT and select the nature of distress. The nature of distress is selectable from below. Nature of distress Fire Contents Fire, explosion Flooding Flooding Collision Collision Grounding Sinking Grounding Listing, in capsizing Sinking Disabled Disabled and adrift Listing danger Undesignated distress Abandoning Abandoning ship Piracy/armed robbery attack Man overboard Man overboard 3)Editing a distress msg Nature :[Fire Position :[NE] :[ 89゚59.0123'N] :[179゚59.6789'E] UTC of pos :[23:59] Mode(fixed) :[Radiotelephone] Attempt type:[Multi-FRQ ] Tx bands :[2/4/6/8/12/16] [Preview] [Tips] [Cancel] of Undesignated Piracy attack 3)Editing a distress msg Nature :[Undesignated ] Position :[NE] :[ 89゚59.0123'N] :[179゚59.6789'E] UTC of pos :[23:59] Mode(fixed) :[Radiotelephone] Attempt type:[Multi-FRQ ] Tx bands :[2/4/6/8/12/16] [Preview] [Tips] [Cancel] 4-49 Operation 33.. Press ENT. The cursor moves to Position. If a valid position and time of that position are already displayed, no entry is necessary. Skip to step 6. 44.. Press ENT and select the quadrant of the position with the jog dial. The quadrant changes from NE Æ NW Æ SE Æ SW Æ CL. Select CL to delete the input information. 55.. After pressing ENT, input the latitude, longitude, and time using the numeric keypad. 66.. Press ENT and select the Mode to change the subsequent communication mode after the DSC call. Either of Radiotelephone or FEC is selectable for the subsequent communicate mode. 77.. Move the cursor to Attempt type and press ENT to change the transmission method for the distress alert. Multi-frequency method is set as the default. To change to the single frequency method, select Single-FRQ with the job dial and press ENT. 88.. Move the cursor to Tx bands and press ENT to change the transmission frequency for the distress alert. ¾ At first, all the frequencies are selected as transmission frequencies. ¾ To change the frequencies, move the cursor by pressing ENT to the frequencies (band) to be unselected, turn the jog dial so they are blank and press ENT. ¾ For the Multi-frequency method, 2 and 8 are fixed and are skipped. Also in this case, it is necessary to select more than one other band. ¾ After completing the Tx bands settings, the cursor returns to Nature. 4-50 3)Editing a distress msg Nature :[Fire Position :[NE] :[ 89゚59.0123'N] :[179゚59.6789'E] UTC of pos :[23:59] Mode(fixed) :[Radiotelephone] Attempt type:[Multi-FRQ ] Tx bands :[2/4/6/8/12/16] [Preview] [Tips] [Cancel] 3)Editing a distress msg Nature :[Fire Position :[NW] :[ 89゚59.0123'N] :[179゚59.6789'E] UTC of pos :[23:59] Mode(fixed) :[Radiotelephone] Attempt type:[Multi-FRQ ] Tx bands :[2/4/6/8/12/16] [Preview] [Tips] [Cancel] 3)Editing a distress msg Nature :[Fire Position :[NW] :[ 89゚59.0123'N] :[179゚59.6789'W] UTC of pos :[23:59] Mode(fixed) :[Radiotelephone] Attempt type:[Multi-FRQ ] Tx bands :[2/4/6/8/12/16] [Preview] [Tips] [Cancel] 3)Editing a distress msg Nature :[Fire Position :[NW] :[ 89゚59.0123'N] :[179゚59.6789'W] UTC of pos :[23:59] Mode :[Radiotelephone] Attempt type:[Multi-FRQ ] Tx bands :[2/4/6/8/12/16] [Preview] [Tips] [Cancel] 3)Editing a distress msg Nature :[Fire Position :[NW] :[ 89゚59.0123'N] :[179゚59.6789'W] UTC of pos :[23:59] Mode(fixed) :[Radiotelephone] Attempt type:[Single-FRQ] Tx bands :[2/4/6/8/12/16] [Preview] [Tips] [Cancel] 3)Editing a distress msg Nature :[Fire Position :[NW] :[ 89゚59.0123'N] :[179゚59.6789'W] UTC of pos :[23:59] Mode(fixed) :[Radiotelephone] Attempt type:[Single-FRQ] Tx bands :[2/ /6/8/12/16] [Preview] [Tips] [Cancel] Operation Note If pressing DISTRESS key during the Tx bands settings (before fixing by pressing ENT), the distress alerts are sent on the band(s) registered previously. 99.. Open the DISTRESS key cover. 1100.. Press and hold the DISTRESS key for 4 seconds until the countdown is completed. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) DSC Rx: 2177.0/Tx: 2177.0kHz 3)Editing a distress msg Nature :[Undesignated ] P o sDiitsitorne s s c:a[lNlE ]s t a r t s [ 89゚59.0123'N] [179゚59.6789'E] U T C o f pions : [ 2 3 :s5e9c] Mode :[Radiotelephone] Attempt type:[Multi-FRQ ] Tx bands :[2/4/6/8/12/16] [Preview] [Tips] [Cancel] Note The rest of the procedure is the same as described in the "Quick distress alerts". Select Preview and press ENT before calling to display the details of the message as shown below. 3)Editing a distress msg Format :Distress Self-ID :431001234 Nature :Fire Position : 89゚59.0123'N :179゚59.6789'E UTC of pos :23:59 Comm type :Radiotelephone EOS :EOS [Return] [Tips] [Cancel] Select Tips and press ENT to display precautions about operations in this screen in a popup screen as shown below. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL Rx: 4015.0/Tx: 4015.0kHz 3)Editing a distress msg N a-t uPrree s s D I S:T[RFEiSrSe k e y t o P o s isteinodn t h e :e[dNiWt]e d m s g . - T o s a v e D I[S T8 9m゚s5g9:.S0a1v2e3 ' N ] - T o u s e s a v[e1d7 9m゚s5g9:.S6e7t8 9 ' W ] U TNCB )oDfE FpAoUsL T :N[O2T3 :C5H9A]N G E D . M o d[eS(afviex]e d[)S e:t[]R a d[iColtoeslee]p h o n e ] Attempt type:[Single-FRQ] Tx bands :[2/ /6/8/12/16] [Preview] [Tips] [Cancel] This popup screen shows the following messages and the handling menus; ・ ・ ・ ・ When sending the edited message, use DISTRESS key on the menu screen. To save the edited message (except Pos/UTC), select Save and press ENT. To load the saved message (except Pos/UTC), select Set and press ENT. The default values of “3. Editing a distress msg” are not changed. 4-51 Operation 4.5.5.3 Receiving distress alerts When a distress alert is received from another ship, displays the event immediately with the specific two-tone alarm sound. WARNING If a distress alert is received, make sure to inform the ship's captain or officer in charge. Doing so may save the lives of the crews and passengers on the ship in distress. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. When a distress alert is received, the distress message is displayed. ¾ The ALM lamp starts blinking, and the receiving alarm gradually grows louder. However, the aural alarm keeps silence if the distress position is not within 500nm, and is not in the polar areas (greater than 70°N/S). ¾ If no procedure exists, starts operating the received message automatically. 22.. Press the CANCEL key or ENT to stop the alarm. Then the screen at right is displayed. ¾ Keep watch for at least 5 minutes. Notify the coast station as appropriate. ¾ If received the same distress alert on another frequency again, the right lower screen is displayed. Then pressing ENT on Accept or leaving 10 seconds changes the frequency to 8291.0 kHz for the radiotelephone mode or 8376.5 kHz for the telex mode. ¾ Press FUNC key or ENT* to move the focused screen to the operation control screen and select the following options to handle the procedure. * If the A mark is not displayed, press ENT to activate this procedure. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 2182.0 2182.0 DST ALT RxID:123456789|DISTRESS ALT Waiting to send ACK(00.2min) Single-FRQ: 2187.5kHz TEL :Rx 2182.0/Tx 2182.0KHz Press CANCEL to silence alarm. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 2182.0 2182.0 DST ALT RxID:123456789|DISTRESS ALT Waiting to send ACK(00.3min) Single-FRQ: 2187.5kHz TEL :Rx 2182.0/Tx 2182.0kHz [ACK][RLY][INF][FRQ][HLD][END] ACK ....... Sends the acknowledgement to the distress alert. RLY ....... Sends the distress relay. INF ........ Indicates the received distress message. FRQ....... Changes the watchkeeping frequency. HLD ....... Makes the procedure on hold. END....... Terminates the procedure. Note 4-52 The distress acknowledgement is normally sent from a coast station. However after consulting with the RCC or a coast station and being directed, it is possible to acknowledge the ship in distress from your own ship. If the distress alert is not received at 2187.5 kHz, the acknowledgement is inhibited and cannot be sent. Incase of the radiotelephone specified, after sending the acknowledgement the frequency is set to 2182.0 kHz. Then start the radiotelephone communication Operation with the ship in distress according to the following procedure. z Say "MAYDAY". z Repeat the identity (MMSI) of the ship in distress 3 times z Say "This is..." z Repeat the identity (MMSI) of your ship 3 times z Say "RECEIVED MAYDAY". 4.5.6 Incase of the FEC specified, after sending the acknowledgement the frequency is set to 2174.5 kHz. Then start the telex communication with the data terminal. The distress relay calls may be received without receiving the distress alert. In this case, keep watch the distress frequency and handle the message using the displayed options as appropriate. Distress relay calls on behalf of someone else (DROBOSE) If another ship is in distress but is itself unable to make a distress alert, and the master of the ship considers that further help is necessary, the distress relay call on behalf of the ship can be transmitted using the "DSC drobose call" menu. In this case, compose a distress relay call format by inputting the MMSI (if known), the ship's position and the time of position (if known), and the nature of distress to send to a specific area or a coast station. CAUTION When sending a drobose call, do NOT press the DISTRESS key. Doing so may cause a false distress alert. (Drobose calls can be sent via the [Call] button displayed on the screen.) ■ Procedure ■ 11.. On the status display or operation display, while pressing and holding MENU key, press 2 SCAN key to open “2. DSC drobose call”. 22.. Select Address and press ENT, input the MMSI of the calling coast station. 2)DSC drobose call Format :[Individual] Address :[ Distress ID:[ Nature :[Undesignated ] Position :[ ] :[ ゚ . ' ] :[ ゚ . ' ] UTC of pos :[ : ] [Call] [Preview] [Cancel] 2)DSC drobose call Format :[Individual] Address :[0 Distress ID:[ Nature :[Undesignated ] Position :[ ] :[ ゚ . ' ] :[ ゚ . ' ] UTC of pos :[ : ] [Call] [Preview] [Cancel] 4-53 Operation 33.. Input the Distress ID (MMSI) of the ship in distress, Nature, Position and/or UTC, if known. The nature of distress is selectable from below. Nature of distress Fire Contents 2)DSC drobose call Format :[Individual] Address :[001234567] Distress ID:[0 Nature :[Undesignated ] Position :[ ] :[ ゚ . ' ] :[ ゚ . ' ] UTC of pos :[ : ] [Call] [Preview] [Cancel] Fire, explosion Flooding Flooding Collision Collision Grounding Sinking Grounding Listing, in capsizing Sinking Disabled Disabled and adrift Listing danger of Undesignated Undesignated distress Abandoning Abandoning ship Piracy/armed robbery attack Man overboard Piracy attack Man overboard 44.. If required, change the communication mode and/or the calling frequency to send the drobose call. Mode: Calling FRQ: Radiotelephone or FEC Distress and safety frequency (2/4/6/8/12/16 MHz) 55.. Select Call and press ENT to make a drobose call. After sending the drobose call, TEL mode is set while waiting for the acknowledgement as shown at right. In this case, the watchkeeping receiver stops scanning frequencies to watch only the calling frequency as shown at right. 2)DSC drobose call Distress ID:[123456789] Nature :[Fire Position :[NE] :[ 89゚59.0000'N] :[179゚59.0000'E] UTC of pos :[23:59] Mode :[Radiotelephone] Calling FRQ:[ 2187.5kHz] [Call] [Preview] [Cancel] ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL 2182.0 2182.0 DST RLY TxTO:001234567|IND|DST RLY Waiting for ACK(00.5min) Call-F:Rx 2187.5/Tx 2187.5kHz TEL :Rx 2182.0/Tx 2182.0kHz [RLY][INF][FRQ][HLD][END] 66.. When receiving the acknowledgement from the coast station, the screen shows as shown at right. ¾ The ALM lamp starts blinking, and the receiving alarm gradually grows louder. ¾ Press the CANCEL key or ENT to silence the alarm, then start the distress traffic. Note 4-54 Such messages can be sent using Area format. In this case, select Area (centre or corner) for the broadcast communication. Operation 4.6 DSC call log DSC messages are classified as received distress messages, received other messages and transmitted messages. The 20 most recent messages for every type are saved in the log. CAUTION Received distress message logs are automatically deleted after 48 hours to avoid accidental resending or other misoperation. Accordingly, if such messages cannot be read, it is not a malfunction. The received distress message logs are cleared when turning off the power by such as the breaker on the power supply. Due to the SOLAS Convention (keeping watch on distress and safety frequencies at all times), do not turn off the equipment when at sea. 4.6.1 Received distress messages The distress alerts, the distress acknowledgements, the distress relay calls, and the distress relay acknowledgements are stored in this log. For the distress alerts, the messages with the same content are received at a maximum of 6 messages for the multi-frequency method or a maximum of 5 messages for the single frequency method, but only one is stored unless otherwise closed the received message during that multiple receptions. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select “4.1 Received distress”. ¾ On the bottom line, the MMSI of the ship is displayed highlighted by the cursor. ¾ If the message includes a reception error (ECC error) ERR is shown in the CAT field. 22.. Select a displayed message and press ENT. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL Rx: 4125.0/Tx: 4125.0kHz 4.1)Received distress No Date/Time CAT Format 0 1 2 0 0 8 - 0 78 - 30 1 12 13 : 23 01 D S T AI LN LD I V 02 2008-07-31 10:33 DST INDIV 03 2008-07-31 10:25 DST AREA 04 2008-07-31 10:03 --- DSTRS 05 2008-07-19 22:53 ERR DSTRS From: 431000123 ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL Rx: 2065.0/Tx: 2065.0kHz Received distress message Type :Distress From :003456789 Nature :Man overboard Position :12゚34.0000'N 123゚45.0000'E UTC of pos:11:20 Mode :Radiotelephone EOS :EOS [Close] 4-55 Operation 4.6.2 Received other messages Received messages other than the distress (routine, safety, and urgency) are stored in this log. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select “4.2 Received others”. ¾ On the bottom line, the MMSI of the ship is displayed highlighted by the cursor. ¾ If the message includes a reception error (ECC error) ERR is shown in the CAT field. 22.. Select a displayed message and press ENT. The selected message is displayed. 4.6.3 Transmitted messages Every transmitted message is stored in this log. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select “4.3 Transmitted calls”. On the bottom line, the MMSI of the ship is displayed highlighted by the cursor. 22.. Select a displayed message and press ENT. The selected message is displayed. 4-56 Operation 4.7 Display of telex communication logs The telex communication is saved automatically as the log, and the reference is available later. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. If displaying the message of "Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode…" on the data terminal, press Enter key on the keyboard. The operation of the data terminal becomes possible in the telex mode, except when the controller is used. 22.. On the main menu and the dropdown menu, select Service Î Call logging history with Enter key. The list of the log as shown at right is displayed. 33.. Move the cursor to the objective file referring to the timestamp and press Enter key to view it. ¾ The file content on the viewer scrolls by the ↑ ↓ key. ¾ To close the file viewer, press the ESC key. Note The maximum size of a log file is 8192 bytes. When exceeding it, the excess data are stored in another file. 4-57 Operation 4.8 USB memory operation This section describes how to use the USB memory. Attention ・ The following conditions are required for the USB memory. Note) Not all USB memories satisfying the every condition are guaranteed. The specification is complied with USB 1.1 or USB 2.0 standards. No USB hub is built-in and is used to connect the USB memory. No security function such as encryption or password to access is included. No write-protect function is included, or that function is set to “Writable”. Already formatted with FAT16 or FAT32 by Windows® OS. ・ Only the USB memory is connectable to the USB memory connector. ・ When the USB memory size is large, the file access time will be longer than small one. ・ The files or folders named with multibyte character prepared by other than the data terminal cannot be accessed. ・ If the USB memory is removed, always close the connector with the rubber cap to ensure the water-proof and dust-proof performance. ・ Initializing the USB memory will erase all data on the USB memory. ・ To avoid abnormal conditions, do not use the USB memory that has the broken file system. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. If displaying the message of "Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode…" on the data terminal, press Enter key on the keyboard. The operation of the data terminal becomes possible in the telex mode, except when the controller is used. [TEL] Tx= 2174.5kHz/Rx= 2174.5kHz File Tune Connect USB Service System Help STATUS INFO Scanning info [No scanning] Tuner/Tx.POWER TUNER :[READY] Tx.POWER :[HIGH] Last status message Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode... 22.. After checking the USB mark indicating on the top of the display of the data terminal, select File from the main menu and the objective dropdown menu. ¾ To start either one of Edit existing file, Rename file, Delete file, or Copy file, input “A:” as the USB drive. ¾ To initialize the USB memory, select Initialize USB and operate in accordance with the message on the dialog box. ¾ To unmount the USB memory, select Remove USB and operate in accordance with the message on the dialog box. After completing the unmount and the USB mark of the top of the display is erased, the USB memory can be safely removed from the data terminal. 4-58 Operation 4.9 Popup screens The contents of the popup screens of the data terminal are as follows (in alphabetical order). Message Buttons Description Yes/ No Is it OK to delete a file? Yes: Deletes the file. No: Cancels this operation. Yes/ No Is it OK to initialize the all items where the cursor can be located. Yes: Initializes them. No: Cancels this operation. Attention Do you really want to change column width? Yes/ No Is it OK to change the column width of a line? Yes: Changes the column width. No: Cancels this operation. Attention Formatting will erase all data on the USB memory. To format the USB memory, choose Yes. Yes/ No All the data of USB memory is deleted by the format operation. Yes: Formats the USB memory. No: Cancel the format. ----- The controller is in operation such as menu and the data terminal cannot be operated now. ----- Now tuning the antenna with the controller, and unavailable for a while. Attention Are you sure to erase? Attention Are you sure to initialize accessible setup data? all of these Attention Keyboard input unavailable now. The connected controller is in operation. Attention The antenna tuning is started controller. Wait a moment, please. by the Yes/ No Is it OK to overwrite the current database file to save the new one? Yes: Overwrites the current file. No: Cancels this operation. OK The print request from the controller or by the data terminal operation has been refused for the printing buffer overflow. Yes/ No When saving a file, detected the file size is exceeding the 8kB. The data terminal can delete the excess data and continue to save the file. Yes: Continues the process. No: Cancels this operation. OK The editing message file size is now beyond 8kB. Please downsize it. Yes/ No The same file name exists. Is it 0K to overwrite it? Yes: Overwrites the current file. No: Cancels this operation. OK No block is selected and refused the request. Select a block in advance. Confirmation Is the frequency free now? Yes/ No Check the frequency is busy or not. Yes: Continues the process. No: Returns to the menu Continue Search? Yes/ No Continue searching the string specified? Yes: Continues searching. No: Cancels this operation. Attention The current database will be lost. Are you sure to continue? Attention The DTE cancels the print request for the DTE printing buffer overflow. Attention The file size exceeds the maximum value, so the DTE deletes excess data. Are you sure? Attention The maximum field size is reached. Attention The same file name already exists. Do you overwrite it? Block has not marked. This function is impossible now. 4-59 Operation Message Buttons Description Error File access failed. OK The specified file cannot be used for any malfunction. Error Invalid file. OK The file is malformed and invalid. Error Keyboard I/F ROM checksum error. OK Detected the keyboard I/F ROM checksum error. Error No folder exists. OK A specified folder is not found. Error No response. OK The controller may be busy and returns no reply to the data terminal. Error Overcurrent has been detected at the USB port. OK The attached USB device may be failure. Error Register the 9-digit Self-ID in advance. OK Own station ID (9digit selcal number) is needed to call the station by the 9 digit selcal number. Error Register this station's ID in advance. OK Own station ID is needed to call the station in the telex mode. Yes/ No The antenna is not tuned. Starts the antenna tuning immediately? Yes: Tunes immediately. No: Tuning is not needed. Error The antenna is not tuned correctly. Tune to the frequency now? Error The attached USB device is not supported. The DTE supports the USB memory only. OK The data terminal detects the USB device except the USB memory. Error The DTE failed to access to the file system. OK The file system and the files are inaccessible now. Error The DTE failed to print. OK Printing is unavailable now. Error The DTE failed to stop the USB drive. OK The USB drive cannot be unmounted. Error The DTE was unable to complete the format. Please remove the USB memory. OK The data terminal failed to format the USB memory, so remove the USB memory. Error The file is too large. OK The specified file cannot be opened because of the file size beyond the 8kB. 4-60 Operation Message Buttons Description Error The file name extension is allowed only “DB”. OK Input “DB” as the correct extension. Error The file name extension is allowed only “TLX”. OK Input “TLX” as the correct extension. Error The file name is wrong. OK The specified file is not found, or the file name to be copied is wrong. Error The file saving failed. There is not enough room on the DTE drive. OK No file can be saved because the data terminal has no sufficient vacant memory. Error The keyboard is disconnected. ----- The keyboard is disconnected and no control for the data terminal is available now. Error The keyboard is not ready. ----- Malfunction is detected at the keyboard I/F and the keyboard is no longer available now. Error The memory is already full. So you cannot make a new file. OK The number of files exceeded maximum value (100), so a new file cannot be made. Error The printer is not ready. Check the paper and online status. OK The printer cannot be used. Confirm that paper is put on or that it is online. Error The same file name already exists. OK This file name already exists, and is no longer available now. Error The station ID is not present. OK SELCAL number (ID) is not registered in the specified radio station. Error There is a possibility of the USB IC failure. All USB functions are disabled. OK Detected the USB IC failure. And now out of work here. Error There is not enough room on the DTE main drive. Delete some files, or change the folder. OK The data terminal has no sufficient vacant memory. Delete files or change the folder adequately. Error There is not enough room on the USB drive. Delete some files, or change the folder. OK The USB memory has no sufficient vacant area. Delete files or change the folder adequately. Error Two or more channels are needed. OK Register two or more channels to start scanning of the specified station.. Error Tx/Rx frequency is not present. OK The frequency is not registered in the specified radio station. 4-61 Operation Message Buttons Description Formatting the USB memory. Please wait. ----- USB memory is being formatted. Wait for a while. Now printing. Please wait. ----- It is printing. Wait for a while. Now reading data. Please wait. ----- Information on the file and the folder is being read. Wait for a while. Now processing NBDP settings. Please wait. ----- The NBDP setting information is now being read or saved. Wait for a while. Now saving data. Please wait. ----- It is saving a file. Wait for a while. Really quit without saving? Yes/ No Is it OK to quit without saving? Yes: Quits immediately No: Returns to the editor. Replace the string? Yes/ No Continue to replace the strings specified? Yes: Replacing. No: Cancels this operation. String not found. OK The data terminal cannot find the string searching. The USB drive is installed and ready to use. OK Recognized the USB memory. The USB memory can removed from the DTE. OK Unmounting the USB drive was completed. The USB memory format complete. OK The format of USB memory was completed. There are no data to be restored. OK There are no data to be restored and Undo is invalid. now be safely To stop the USB drive, choose Yes. After the USB drive is stopped, the USB drive can be safely removed. Waiting for the tuner answer… Warning The USB memory was removed unmounting that drive. 4-62 without Yes/ No Select Yes when you unmount the USB drive. After unmounting, USB memory can be removed. ----- Now waiting for the answer from the antenna tuner. Just a moment, please. OK Removing the USB memory without unmounting may cause the malfunction of the USB memory. Settings & Registrations 5. SETTINGS & REGISTRATIONS This chapter describes the procedures for settings and registrations such as manual date and time settings, registration of channels in each mode, advanced DSC settings, printer settings, and other settings for the equipment. 5.1 Date and time settings Normally, the date and time are updated automatically if importing GPS information. But, if necessary, input these parameters manually as follows. CAUTION The time in the 7.1 Date & time menu means the present time, and is different from the time in the 7.2 POS/TIME menu that means the time when the position information is valid. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select 7.1 Date & time. 7.1)Date & time 1.Date 2.Present time 3.Display form - UTC/LT - LT diff :2011-12-30 :23:59 :UTC 0.Back 22.. To input the date, press ENT. Input the year, month, and date with the numeric keypad or jog dial, and press ENT. 7.1)Date & time 1.Date 2.Present time 3.Display form - UTC/LT - LT diff :2012-12-30 :23:59 :UTC 0.Back 33.. After completing the above steps, the cursor moves to 2. Present time. 7.1)Date & time 1.Date 2.Present time 3.Display form - UTC/LT - LT diff :2012-12-31 :23:59 :UTC 0.Back 5-1 Settings & Registrations 44.. To input the present time, press ENT. ¾ Input the hours and minutes with the numeric keypad or jog dial, and press ENT. ¾ To close this menu after completing the date and time settings, place the cursor on any one of the selectable items and press the CANCEL key. Note 5-2 7.1)Date & time 1.Date 2.Present time 3.Display form - UTC/LT - LT diff :2012-12-31 :23:59 :UTC 0.Back In addition to the above, the following items can be set in this menu. UTC/LT: Select a type of time, Universal Time Coordinated (UTC) or Local Time (LT), shown on the screen. LT diff: Set the local time difference to display the local time. Settings & Registrations 5.2 Own ship position and time settings Normally, the ship's position and the time are updated automatically if importing GPS information. But, if necessary, input these parameters manually as follows. CAUTION The time in the 7.2 POS/TIME menu means the time when the position information is valid, and is different from the present time mentioned in the 7.1 Date & time menu. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select 7.2 POS/TIME. 7.2)POS/TIME 1.Own position:NE 89゚59.1234'N 179゚59.1234'E 2.UTC of position: 23:59 0.Back 22.. To input your own ship's position, press ENT. Select the position quadrant with the jog dial, and press ENT. Then input the latitude and longitude with the numeric keypad or jog dial, and press ENT. 33.. When completing the input of the ship’s position, the cursor moves to the time column of the 2. UTC of position. ¾ Input the hours and minutes with the numeric keypad or jog dial, and press ENT. 7.2)POS/TIME 1.Own position:NE 89゚59.1234'N 179゚59.1234'E 2.UTC of position: 23:59 0.Back 7.2)POS/TIME 1.Own position:NE 89゚59.1234'N 179゚59.1234'E 2.UTC of position: 23:59 0.Back ¾ Just after inputting the position, the present time is input to this column automatically. ¾ To close this menu after completing the setting, press the CANCEL key. Note After the position and the time information are input manually, that information is not overwritten with an external device, such as a GPS, automatically. If using the GPS information after manually inputting data, set the quadrant field mentioned above to “GPS”. If the position and the time information are not received, from a GPS or other device within 10 minutes after powering on, or after 10 minutes has elapsed since the external input was interrupted, the alarm screen may appear. Further, regardless of either manual or automatic input, if the position and the time are not updated within 4 hours since the last entry, the alarm screen also appears. 5-3 Settings & Registrations 5.3 Controller settings The following describes the procedure regarding individual settings for the controller such as LCD adjustment. 5.3.1 LCD adjustment The LCD conditions for viewability are adjustable as follows. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select 7.3.1 LCD adjustment. 7.3.1)LCD adjustment 1.Contrast 2.Dimmer Maximum Typical Minimum 3.Screen saver : Timer(sec): 0.Back The screen as shown at right is displayed. 06 10 08 06 OFF 060 22.. Move the cursor to the desired item and press ENT. Then alter the settings as appropriate with the numeric keypad or jog dial, and press ENT again. ¾ Set each item within the ranges given below: Contrast: 1 - 11 Dimmer: 1 - 10 Screen saver: ON/OFF Timer: 1 - 999 seconds 7.3.1)LCD adjustment 1.Contrast : 06 2.Dimmer Maximum : 10 Typical : 08 Minimum : 06 3.Screen saver : OFF Timer(sec): 060 0.Back ¾ To close this menu, place the cursor on any one of the selectable items and press the CANCEL key. 5.3.2 Sound settings Sound settings such as the click beep are adjustable as follows. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select 7.3.2 Sound. The screen as shown at right is displayed. 7.3.2)Sound 1.Operation - Speaker : ON - Click : ON 2.Notification level: 7 3.Sidetone : ON 0.Back 22.. Move the cursor to the desired item and press ENT. Then set the conditions as appropriate with the numeric keypad or jog dial, and press ENT again. ¾ Notification level for a tone can be set within 1 - 7. ¾ When Sidetone is set to ON, an 800 Hz tone sounds during keying in. ¾ To close this menu, place the cursor on any one of the selectable items and press the CANCEL key. 5-4 7.3.2)Sound 1.Operation - Speaker : ON - Click : ON 2.Notification level: 7 3.Sidetone : ON 0.Back Settings & Registrations 5.3.3 User key assignments User key assignment enables the desired menu to be displayed immediately without moving through the hierarchical menus, and is assignable as follows. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through 7.3.3)User key assign hierarchical menus, select 7.3.3 User key assign. 1.DSC non-distress call 2.DSC drobose call 3.Editing a distress msg 4.DSC logs 5.Radio operation 6.User channel list 7.ITU channel list 8.Receiver The screen at right is displayed. If the desired menu has already been registered, the cursor is placed on that menu. 22.. Move the cursor to the desired menu to be registered with the jog dial. The assignable menus are as follows: 1. DSC non-distress call (Menu1) 18. POS/TIME 2. DSC drobose call (Menu2) 19. My controller (Menu7.3) 3. Editing a distress msg (Menu3) 20. LCD adjustment (Menu7.3.1) 4. DSC logs (Menu4) 21. Sound (Menu7.3.2) 5. Radio operation (Menu5) 22. User channels (Menu7.4) 6. User channel list (Menu5.1) 23. DSC/WKR condition (Menu7.5) 7. ITU channel list (Menu5.2) 24. Automatic ACK (Menu7.5.1) 8. Receiver (Menu5.4) 25. WKR scanning FRQ (Menu7.5.2) 9. Scan (Menu5.4.7) 26. Option (Menu7.6) 10. Transmitter (Menu5.5) 27. CH dial lock ON/OFF --- 11. Maintenance (Menu6) 28. 2182kHz --- 12. Self diagnosis (Menu6.1) 29. AM mode 13. DSC loop (Menu6.1.1) 30. DSC alarm setting (Menu7.3.3) 14. Alarm information (Menu6.2) 31. Group ID (Menu7.5.6) 15. Software version (Menu6.3) 32. Inactivity timeout (Menu7.5.7) 16. Setup (Menu7) 33. DSC call list (Menu7.5.8) 17. Date & time (Menu7.1) 33.. Press ENT to complete registration. After registration, the screen returns to the previous hierarchical menu as shown at right. Note (Menu7.2) --- 7.3)My controller 1.LCD adjustment 2.Sound 3.User key assign 4.Tx meter 5.Data transfer 6.Menu shutdown 7.CH search ref 0.Back :PWR :10min :40 When the USER key is pressed in the factory default setting, 7.3 My controller menu is immediately displayed. 5-5 Settings & Registrations 5.3.4 Selecting Tx meters The meter displayed in the status display indicates the strength of the received signal (S meter). However, it can also indicate one of Tx power, antenna current, PA voltage, PA current or key information during transmission. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select 7.3 My controller. The screen as shown at right is displayed. 22.. Move the cursor to 4. Tx meter with the numeric keypad or jog dial. 33.. Press ENT, and select the meter type with the jog dial. The selectable meters are as follows: PWR .... Tx power Ia ........ Antenna current Vc ....... PA voltage Ic ........ PA current Key…….Key information* * When keying during the ARQ communication, the Key is indicated regardless of this setting. 44.. Press ENT to confirm the selection. The setting is complete. 5-6 7.3)My controller 1.LCD adjustment 2.Sound 3.User key assign 4.Tx meter :PWR 5.Data transfer 6.Menu shutdown :10min 7.CH search ref :40 0.Back 7.3)My controller 1.LCD adjustment 2.Sound 3.User key assign 4.Tx meter :PWR 5.Data transfer 6.Menu shutdown :10min 7.CH search ref :40 0.Back 7.3)My controller 1.LCD adjustment 2.Sound 3.User key assign 4.Tx meter :Ia 5.Data transfer 6.Menu shutdown :10min 7.CH search ref :40 0.Back 7.3)My controller 1.LCD adjustment 2.Sound 3.User key assign 4.Tx meter :Ia 5.Data transfer 6.Menu shutdown :10min 7.CH search ref :40 0.Back Settings & Registrations 5.3.5 Transferring user channel data to another controller When 2 controllers are connected, stored information (user channel table) can be transferred from the controller having access rights to another controller (monitor condition). ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select 7.3 My controller. 22.. Move the cursor to 5. Data transfer with the numeric keypad or jog dial and press ENT. The popup screen as shown at right is displayed. 33.. Press ENT to confirm the selection. ¾ ¾ The popup screen as shown at right is displayed to indicate the controller's status for forwarding. The screen at right (below) is displayed on the monitor. If OK is selected or the screen is left as it is for 10 seconds, transferring of stored information is started. 7.3)My controller 1.LCD adjustment 2.Sound 3.User key assign 4.Tx meter :PWR 5.Data transfer 6.Menu shutdown :10min 7.CH search ref :40 0.Back 7.3)My controller 1.LCD OK adjustment to transfer the 2.Sound user channels to 3.User key assign another controller? 4.Tx meter : Ia [ OKtransfer [Cancel] 5.Data 6.Menu shutdown :10min 7.CH search ref :40 0.Back 7.3)My controller 1.LCD adjustment 2.Sound Wait a moment, please. 3.User key assign 4.Tx meter : Ia 5.Data transfer 6.Menu shutdown :10min 7.CH search ref :40 0.Back OK to update this user channel table? [ OK ] [Cancel] [Display on monitor] 44.. Forwarding of stored information is started. ¾ ¾ ¾ During forwarding, the popup screen as shown at right is displayed. The screen at right (below) is displayed on the monitor. The previous screen is returned to when forwarding is completed. Note To cancel forwarding midway, press the CANCEL key or ENT. 7.3)My controller 1.LCD adjustment 2.Sound Data sending... 3.User key assign 4.Tx meter : Ia [Cancel] 5.Data transfer 6.Menu shutdown :10min 7.CH search ref :40 0.Back Updating the table... [Cancel] [Display on monitor] 5-7 Settings & Registrations 5.3.6 Setting the inactivity timer (for menu shutdown) To close menus of the controller automatically which is left as opening menus, the inactivity timer can be set according to the following procedure. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select 7.3 My controller. 22.. Move the cursor to 6. Menu shutdown with the numeric keypad or jog dial, and press ENT. 33.. Input the timer value and press ENT. ¾ ¾ 5.3.7 The range is from 00 to 60 minutes. To set this timer to OFF, input 00. In this case, the screen shows OFF as shown at right. 7.3)My controller 1.LCD adjustment 2.Sound 3.User key assign 4.Tx meter :PWR 5.Data transfer 6.Menu shutdown :10min 7.CH search ref :40 0.Back 7.3)My controller 1.LCD adjustment 2.Sound 3.User key assign 4.Tx meter :PWR 5.Data transfer 6.Menu shutdown :OFF 7.CH search ref :40 0.Back Setting the reference value for the channel auto search When making a DSC routine call, the controller searches the working channel (frequency) automatically by checking the every channel busy referring the signal level with the value set as follows. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select 7.3 My controller. 22.. Move the cursor to 7. CH search ref with 7.3)My controller 1.LCD adjustment 2.Sound 3.User key assign 4.Tx meter :PWR 5.Data transfer 6.Menu shutdown :10min 7.CH search ref :40 0.Back the numeric keypad or jog dial, and press ENT. 33.. Input the reference value and press ENT. The range is from 00 to 50. 5-8 7.3)My controller 1.LCD adjustment 2.Sound 3.User key assign 4.Tx meter :PWR 5.Data transfer 6.Menu shutdown :OFF 7.CH search ref :45 0.Back Settings & Registrations 5.4 Registering user channels Often used frequencies at the controller for the radiotelephone, CW, and DSC mode can be registered as user channels and used in scanning radio settings or groups. A total of 20 groups with 20 channels set to each group (i.e. 400 channels) can be registered. Furthermore, the user channels of the telex frequency can be registered to the station list of the data terminal. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select 7.4 User channels (index). 22.. Select the desired row or group to be edited with the numeric keypad or jog dial. The screen at right is displayed. (This example is for new registration to group 03.) Also, if an unregistered group is opened, TEL is displayed at Type as the default. 33.. Press ENT to enter the group name. Up to 18 characters can be registered. The following characters are available: Alphabet (capital and small letters) Numbers 0 - 9 The following signs, space and determination symbol (◄) [ ] _ " # % & ' ( ) ? @ + - / = : ; < > Group names can be omitted. ¾ ¾ ¾ 44.. Select a character and press ENT one by one. ¾ When inputting numbers with the numeric keypad ENT is not needed. ¾ To return to the previous letter, press the CANCEL key. 7.4)User channels (index) No CH group name Type 01 JRC Tokyo TEL CW 02 Pacific ABC 03 04 05 06 07 08 7.4)User channels (table) Name: Type: TEL CHNo Rx[kHz] Tx[kHz] 041 042 043 044 045 046 7.4)User channels (table) Name: ◄ Type: TEL CHNo Rx[kHz] Tx[kHz] 041 042 043 044 045 046 7.4)User channels (table) Name: Japan Radio◄ Type: TEL CHNo Rx[kHz] Tx[kHz] 041 042 043 044 045 046 Mode Mode Mode ¾ To complete name entry of 18 characters long, press ENT after selecting the last character by the jog dial. Or, if the name is less than 18 characters long, following the name, select the determination symbol (◄), as shown at right and press ENT. Note The character sequence shown by turning the jog dial is as follows: ◄AB C D E F G H I J K LM N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s t u v w x y z [ ] _ " # % & ' ( ) ? @ + - / = : ; < > 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 (space) 5-9 Settings & Registrations 55.. After completing the above steps, the cursor returns to Type. ¾ If necessary, change the group attribute (communication mode or custom). ¾ The following attributes can be selected: 7.4)User channels (table) Name: Japan Radio Type: TEL CHNo Rx[kHz] Tx[kHz] 041 042 043 044 045 046 Mode TEL ··········· Radiotelephone mode DSC ··········· Digital selective calling mode CW ············ Continuous wave mode Custom Communication mode mix 66.. When setting of group attributes is completed, the cursor returns to the topmost row of the channel number. (CHNo). 7.4)User channels (table) Name: Japan Radio Type: TEL CHNo Rx[kHz] Tx[kHz] 041 042 043 044 045 046 Mode 77.. Select the channel number to register with the jog dial, and press ENT. Register as follows in the popup screen at right. ¾ When the group attribute is Custom, specify the communication mode at Mode. Otherwise, the communication mode is fixed to the mode specified at Type. ¾ To reference a frequency from the ITU channel, move the cursor to ITU channel, press ENT, and specify that channel number. 7.4)User channels (table) Name: Japan Radio TEL CHNo. 041/Type Type: TEL Mode :TEL CHNoITURx[kHz] Channel :Tx[kHz] 041Rx freq(kHz) : 042Tx freq(kHz) : 043[OK] [Cancel] [Erase] 044 045 046 Mode ¾ Move the cursor to Rx freq(kHz), press ENT, and enter the Rx frequency. ¾ Move the cursor to Tx freq(kHz), press ENT, and enter the Tx frequency. 88.. After completing the above steps, move the cursor to OK, and press ENT to complete registration. ¾ Follow the same procedure above to create a group of channels. ¾ Already registered channels can be changed by the above procedure. 7.4)User channels (table) Name: Japan Radio Type: TEL CHNo Rx[kHz] Tx[kHz] 041 4071.0 4071.0 042 043 044 045 046 Mode TEL ¾ To close this menu, place the cursor on any one of the registration numbers, and press the CANCEL key. Note 5-10 To delete an already registered channel, move the cursor to Erase in the above popup screen, and press ENT. To erase an already registered group, move the cursor to "000 ALL CLEAR function" in the bottommost row of the channel list, and press ENT. Next, move the cursor to OK in the confirmation screen, and press ENT. To erase all already registered groups, move the cursor to "00 ALL CLEAR function" in the User channels (index) screen, and press ENT. Next, move the cursor to OK in the confirmation screen, and press ENT. When the 7.6.1 Connection is set to DTE, the group 20 becomes the reserved group for telex channels of the data terminal and inaccessible at the controller. Settings & Registrations 5.5 Advanced settings for DSC/WKR The following describes the procedure for the advanced DSC settings such as automatic acknowledgement, as well as setting the watch frequency of the watch keeping receiver. ■ Menu screen ■ Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select 7.5 DSC/WKR condition. The following describes the procedures from this screen. Note that the screen at right shows factory default settings. 5.5.1 7.5)DSC/WKR condition 1.Automatic ACK 2.WKR scanning FRQ 3.DSC alarm setting 4.Medical use 5.Neutral use 6.Group ID 7.Inactivity timeout 8.DSC call list :OFF :OFF Automatic acknowledgement While the automatic acknowledgement is set to ON, and no menu is displayed and there is no active procedure, if either one of the individual calls below is received, the acknowledgement is sent automatically. Safety test call Safety position request call Routine polling call Individual call requesting communication without valid frequency (*) (*) In this case, the “unable to comply” acknowledgement is sent. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Move the cursor to 1. Automatic ACK, and press ENT. The screen as shown at right is displayed. 7.5.1)Automatic ACK 1.Test call 2.Position RQ call 3.Polling call 4.Individual call :ON :OFF :ON :ON 0.Back 22.. Set the call setting targeted for automatic acknowledgement to ON. 5.5.2 Setting DSC watch frequency Set the frequency to watch on the WKR (DSC watch keeping receiver). ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Move the cursor to 2. WKR scanning FRQ, and press ENT. The screen as shown at right is displayed. 22.. Press ENT, and set another frequency in 7.5.2)WKR scanning FRQ 1.Registration - CH1 2187.5kHz - CH2 4207.5kHz - CH3 6312.0kHz - CH4 8414.5kHz - CH5 12577.0kHz - CH6 16804.5kHz 0.Back :(Const) :OFF :ON :(Const) :ON :OFF addition to 2187.5 kHz and 8414.5 kHz to ON. Note In accordance with the SOLAS Convention, 2187.5 kHz and 8414.5 kHz cannot be turned OFF. 5-11 Settings & Registrations 5.5.3 Setting receiving alarms The DSC receiving alarm can be set as follows. ■ Procedure ■ Move the cursor to 3. DSC alarm setting, and press ENT. The screen as shown at right is displayed. Change the settings as appropriate. 7.5.3)DSC alarm setting 1.Safety/Routine RX ALM :ON 2.Distress RX ALM - Maximum distance(NM):500 - Self-terminating :OFF 0.Back ¾ To disable the receiving alarms for routine and safety calls, set 1. Safety/Routine RX ALM to OFF. ¾ The receiving alarms condition of distress alerts or distress relay calls can be changed using the menu 2. Distress RX ALM as follows. - Normally when receiving a new distress event, the receiving alarm has to be stopped manually. However if the ship in distress is located within 70 degree north and 70 degree south latitude, and farther than the Maximum distance value while the Selfterminating set is ON, the alarm is treated as the self-terminating alarm. - The Maximum distance can be set within the range of 500 to 999 NM. Note1) If making this value valid, always set the Self-terminating to ON. Note2) If receiving DSC messages from the ships located out of range, the messages are handled normally except the alarm sound. 5.5.4 Using medical/neutral settings for urgency calls Set the condition so that an urgency area call containing the additional subject of either "Medical transportation" or "Neutral nationality" can be sent. It is useful for the situation when sailing dangerous waters such as in areas of political instability, and needed to inform receivers of the additional information if any of the following apply. - Own ship is performing medical transportation and protected under the 1949 Geneva Convention. - Own ship is of neutral nationality in accordance with ITU resolution 18 (Mob-83). Additionally note that this setting is returned to the default (OFF) if the power is turned off. ■ Procedure ■ To use these kinds of calls, set 4. Medical use or 5. Neutral use condition to ON. 5.5.5 Registering the ship's group ID Register the group ID (group ship ID number) for receiving group calls. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Move the cursor to 6. Group ID, and press ENT. The screen as shown at right is displayed. 22.. Move the cursor to register the ID number and press ENT, then input the 9 digits ID (leftmost digit fixed to 0). ¾ Upto 20 groups can be registered. ¾ When finished, press CANCEL key. 5-12 7.5.6)Group ID No 9-digit ID number 01 043100001 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 Settings & Registrations 5.5.6 Setting the inactivity timer (for procedures on hold) When making a procedure on hold, the procedure is automatically terminated after the time set as follows. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Move the cursor to 7. Inactivity timeout, and press ENT. The screen as shown at right is displayed. Change the settings as appropriate. 1. ACKed distress alert 7.5.7)Inactivity timeout 1.ACKed distress alert:OFF 2.RCVed other distress:OFF 3.Non-distress call :15min 4.Other communications:030sec 0.Back The acknowledged distress alert events sent from the own ship: - The range is 00 (OFF) to 60 minutes. 2. RCVed other distress The distress events of other ships - The range is 00 (OFF) to 60 minutes. 3. Non-distress call Routine, safety and urgency events - The range is 00 (OFF) to 60 minutes. 4. Other communications Communications without using DSC - The range is 010 to 600 seconds. 5.5.7 Registering the DSC call list To call the station using the DSC, registers the station names, MMSI and the calling frequencies as follows. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Move the cursor to 8. DSC call list, and press ENT. The screen as shown at right is displayed. 7.5.8)DSC call list No Station name MMSI 01 JRC Mitaka1 431000001 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 22.. Move the cursor to the line to be changed and press ENT to display the frequency list as shown at right. 33.. Input data as appropriate using the numeric keypad or jog dial. 7.5.8)DSC call list(FRQ) Name:JRC Mitaka1 MMSI:431000001 No Rx[kHz] Tx[kHz] Category 01 2177.0 2189.5 RTN 02 4219.5 4208.0 RTN 03 4220.0 4208.5 RTN 04 4220.5 4209.0 RTN 05 06 ¾ Upto 20 channels for every 20 stations can be registered. ¾ When finished, press CANCEL key. 5-13 Settings & Registrations 5.6 Setting connections for options When setting connections between the controller and optional devices, such as a printer, configure the conditions as appropriate according to the device type, as follows. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through 7.6)Option hierarchical menus, select 7.6 Option. 1.Connection 2.Data out 3.Baudrate 4.Flow control 5.Print direction :None/CMD :--:--:--:--- 0.Back 22.. Move the cursor to the desired item, and press ENT. Move the cursor to the right. Then select the condition as appropriate and press ENT. 7.6)Option 1.Connection 2.Data out 3.Baudrate 4.Flow control 5.Print direction :None/CMD :--:--:--:--- 0.Back Note - The content and the selectable conditions of each item are as follows. Item Name Content Selectable conditions : Factory default) Connection Connection status and printer type None/CMD/ Serial PRN/ NKG-800/ DTE Data out Printing method for DSC messages ---/ Auto/ Manual Baudrate Transmission speed to printer ---/ 4.8k/ 9.6k/ 38.4k/ 57.6kbps Flow control Handshake setting with printer ---/ None/ Hard Print direction Printing sequence of lines ---/ Upright/ Invert - When connecting a serial printer (e.g. NKG-91), set the items as follows: 1.Connection :Serial PRN 2.Data out :Auto 3.Baudrate :4.8k 4.Flow control :Hard 5.Print direction :Invert (NKG-91)/Upright (DPU-414) - When connecting the NKG-800 printer, set the items as follows: 1.Connection :NKG-800 2.Data out :Auto - If no option is connected, select None/CMD at the Connection. Note) When None/CMD is set, connect nothing to the serial port. - When connecting the data terminal to the controller for the telex communication, set Connection item to DTE. Note that restart the system just after this setting. Moreover, Baudrate, Flow control and Print direction become unchangeable in this case. 5-14 Settings & Registrations 5.7 Setting of data terminal The following describes the procedure regarding LCD adjustment, such as the color settings and brightness, and registration of the station list. 5.7.1 LCD adjustment ■ Procedure ■ 11.. If displaying the message of "Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode…" on the data terminal, press Enter key on the keyboard. The operation of the data terminal becomes possible in the telex mode, except when the controller is used. 22.. On the main menu and the dropdown menu, select System Î Config with Enter key. The setting conditions concerning to the screen are displayed. Config LCD/LED dimmer (0-15) LCD/LED dimmer button setting Screensaver setting - Function ON/OFF - Starting time (1-15) Display color pattern User defined color setting - Background color of main display: - Text color of main display - Background color of H&F display : - Text color of H&F display - Shortcut character color Set 13 ON 3 minutes Ocean Day Green White Lime Navy Orange Cancel 33.. Select the item to be changed by the cursor and press Enter key, then input the appropriate condition. Set the item using the numeric keypad or dropdown menu, where the cursor moves to the right as shown at right. As for other items, the specific menu is displayed. 5-15 Settings & Registrations 44.. When completing the setting, move the cursor to the Set and press Enter key. Note The content of each setting item is as follows. Item 5-16 Content of setting Remarks Without using this menu, the dimmer is adjustable with Ctrl+Ç or Ctrl+È operation. LCD/LED dimmer (0-15) Adjusts the brightness of the LCD and the panel lamp by 16 steps. LCD/LED dimmer button setting Sets the brightness of the LCD and the panel lamp when using the DIM key on the panel. Screensaver setting - Function ON/OFF Sets the screen saver ON/OFF. - Starting time (1-15) Sets the time until the screensaver starts. Display color pattern Sets the color of the screen from the following 9 patterns of the dropdown list. - Ocean Day/ Dusk/ Night - Earth Day/ Dusk/ Night - Basic Black/ White - User defined User defined color setting - Background color of main display Sets the background color of the main screen from the following. Black/ Gray/ Silver/ White/ Maroon/ Red/ Olive/ Yellow/ Green/ Lime/ Teal/ Cyan/ Navy/ Blue/ Purple/ Magenta/ Orange ・ This menu is valid only when Display color pattern = User defined. ・ Setting the same color with the main screen or the short cut character is inhibited. - Text color of main display Sets the text color of the main screen from the following. Black/ Gray/ Silver/ White/ Maroon/ Red/ Olive/ Yellow/ Green/ Lime/ Teal/ Cyan/ Navy/ Blue/ Purple/ Magenta/ Orange ・ This menu is valid only when Display color pattern = User defined. ・ Setting the same color with the background of the main screen is inhibited. - Background color of H&F display Sets the background color of the header/footer screen from the following. Black/ Gray/ Silver/ White/ Maroon/ Red/ Olive/ Yellow/ Green/ Lime/ Teal/ Cyan/ Navy/ Blue/ Purple/ Magenta/ Orange ・ This menu is valid only when Display color pattern = User defined. ・ Setting the same color with the text of the header/footer screen is inhibited. - Text color of H&F display Sets the text color of the header/ footer screen from the following. Black/ Gray/ Silver/ White/ Maroon/ Red/ Olive/ Yellow/ Green/ Lime/ Teal/ Cyan/ Navy/ Blue/ Purple/ Magenta/ Orange ・ This menu is valid only when Display color pattern = User defined. ・ Setting the same color with the background of the header/footer screen is inhibited. - Shortcut character color Sets the shortcut character color from the following. Black/ Gray/ Silver/ White/ Maroon/ Red/ Olive/ Yellow/ Green/ Lime/ Teal/ Cyan/ Navy/ Blue/ Purple/ Magenta/ Orange ・ This menu is valid only when Display color pattern = User defined. ・ Setting the same color with the background of the main screen is inhibited. The screensaver is invalid at the following cases; ・ communicating in the telex mode, ・ running self-diagnosis. Settings & Registrations 5.7.2 Registering station list ■ Procedure ■ 11.. If displaying the message of "Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode…" on the data terminal, press Enter key on the keyboard. The operation of the data terminal becomes possible in the telex mode, except when the controller is used. 22.. On the main menu and the dropdown menu, select Service Î Station list with Enter key. The station list is displayed. No. Station Name 1 Station 01 2 Station 02 3 Station 03 10 ID 004310123 004311234 431012345 Station list Location N33゚45' E138゚12' N37゚22' E135゚51' F.Sig DOTDOT DOTDOT [Edit] [Erase] [Print] [Cancel] ↓ 33.. Select the line to be registered newly or to be changed with the cursor and press Enter key. Then input the station information including the channels on the station list edit screen. ¾ Input the radio station name within 16 characters to Station Name column. (The @ character is unavailable.) ¾ Input 4 (coast station), 5 (ships station) or 9 digits SELCAL number to Station ID column. ¾ The Location and Free CH Sig are optional. ¾ Move the cursor to the line to be registered and press Enter key. Then input the Tx/Rx frequencies on the popup screen at right. 44.. After inputting, press Enter key to close the screen and finish the registration. 5-17 Settings & Registrations Note 5-18 There is the station database menu (Service Î Station database) as a similar registration menu to register the station information. The station database operation is basically the same with the station list. However note that the station list is designed for the manual input only, but the station database is designed to register the station information more easily such as copying the original station database prepared in advance. The functions available on the station database screen are as follows. ・ Program ·············· Registers the station information located cursor to the desired line of the station list. with the ・ Read ··················· Reads the station database saved in the flash ROM or the USB memory. ・ Write ··················· Saves the prepared station database in another drive or the folder. ・ Get ····················· Loads station information of the station list on a line of the station database. Settings & Registrations 5.8 Setting telex mode The following describes the procedure to check or set the condition for the telex communication. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. If displaying the message of "Press Enter key to get the access right in the NBDP mode…" on the data terminal, press Enter key on the keyboard. The operation of the data terminal becomes possible in the telex mode, except when the controller is used. 22.. On the main menu and the dropdown menu, select System Î NBDP setup with Enter key. The setting conditions concerning to the telex communication are displayed. 33.. Select the item to be changed with the cursor, and press Enter key. The input screen as shown at right is displayed. ※ An example of Max. FEC error rate Setup data input Max. FEC error rate : [ 30] % Input range is from 1 to 100. Set Cancel 44.. Press Enter key to move the cursor to the right. Then input the value and press Enter key again. The cursor moves to Set. Setup data input Max. FEC error rate : [ 30] % Input range is from 1 to 100. Set Cancel 5-19 Settings & Registrations 55.. When the cursor is located on Set, press Enter key to set the value and close the popup screen. 66.. After completing the every input, move the cursor to Set and press Enter key to save and finish the registration. Note When selecting the Initialize with the cursor and pressing Enter key, the every accessible item is reset to the factory default setting. The content of each item and the factory default setting values are as follows. Item Setting contents Initial value Remarks When setting this item, contact our company or agency. ARQ/FEC 4- or 5-digit Self-ID Registers the SELCAL number. ※ 4-digit is for the coast station. ----- GFEC 4- or 5-digit Self-ID Registers the group ID. ※ 4-digit is for the coast station ----- ARQ/FEC 9-digit Self-ID 9-digit SELCAL number for reference. ----- GFEC 9-digit Self-ID Registers the 9-digit group ID. ----- Answerback Registers the answerback code used with WRU and Hereis. ----- Max. FEC error rate Sets the permissible error rate that occurs during CFEC receiving. 30 % Max. automatic call series Sets times to retry calling a station if failed to call the station using the CALL function. Collective FEC receiving Sets ON/OFF of the CFEC or SFEC receiving. ON Time duration for AUTO Sets the interval time until retrying if failed to call a coast station using the AUTOTELEX function. 10 min Restart Sets ON/OFF of the rephasing function if disconnected the communication in ARQ mode. ON Finite start/restart Sets ON/OFF of the limit of the ARQ call times, which is 128 times for phasing and 32 times for rephasing. ON Transmitter pre-key time Sets a period between key on and starting the signal output. 10 ms 5-20 Common with the DSC When setting this item, contact our company or agency. Optional Optional Maintenance & Inspection 6. MAINTENANCE & INSPECTION The performance and lifetime of the equipment depend on appropriate maintenance. This chapter describes an outline of maintenance and inspection, self diagnosis and troubleshooting. 6.1 General maintenance & inspection In order to operate the equipment under optimum conditions, it is vital to perform regular inspections and also, to keep accurate records. Inspections enable problems to be identified before they become major malfunctions. The following inspections should be made regularly. Inspection sequence Inspection item Procedure Antenna system Check that antennas and the connectors are secure. RF GAIN function In the radiotelephone mode (TEL), turn the RF GAIN control on the controller having access rights. Is the radio static (noise) from the speaker adjustable? Receiver condition check by speaker output Check that the voice level and noise level are not abnormally loud or soft. Handset PTT switch In the radiotelephone (TEL) mode, press the PTT switch, and check that the unit transmits immediately on the Tx meter or by TX and ON displayed on the screen. Transmission and reception check by performing radio communication In the radiotelephone (TEL) mode, check that normal conversation is possible. Condition of the data terminal When the communication mode is other than the telex mode (e.g. TEL mode), check that the communication mode can be set to the telex mode by pressing the Enter key on the keyboard of the data terminal. Air filter Check that if the air filters of the power supply and/or the battery charger are clogged with dust. 6-1 Maintenance & Inspection 6.2 Self diagnosis inspection The following describes the procedure for performing self diagnosis in the 6.1 Self diagnosis menu. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press FUNC Î 8 T E S T . The 6.1 Self diagnosis menu is displayed. 6.1)Self diagnosis 1.Transceiver 2.Controller/DTE 3.Transceiver log 4.Controller/DTE log 5.DSC/NBDP loop 6.Printout :Valid 0.Back 22.. Select Transceiver, Controller/DTE, or DSC/NBDP loop. ¾ When Transceiver is selected, the screen at right is displayed. ¾ For DSC/NBDP loop, a shortcut menu for diagnosing the modem is as shown in the screen at right. 33.. In the above screen, press ENT, select the diagnosis mode with the jog dial, and press ENT. Self diagnosis is performed. The following test modes are available: 6.1.1) Transceiver ........ ALL (all modes) TRX&MODEM PA&ATU WKR MODEM TRX PA ATU 6.1.2) Controller/DTE ... ALL (all modes) DGT CKT AF output LCD&LED Speaker Printer DTE Note 6-2 6.1.1)Transceiver Target - ATU 1.Serial I/F 2.RBK port 3.Band1 input 4.Band1 tune 5.Band2 input 6.Band2 tune 7.Band3 input 6.1.1)Transceiver Target - ATU 1.Serial I/F 2.RBK port 3.Band1 input 4.Band1 tune 5.Band2 input 6.Band2 tune 7.Band3 input 6.1.1)Transceiver Target - ATU 1.Serial I/F 2.RBK port 3.Band1 input 4.Band1 tune 5.Band2 input 6.Band2 tune 7.Band3 input :ALL :TRX&MODEM :ATU :OK :Checking - If the jog dial is turned while the cursor is at Target when Transceiver is selected, the diagnosis items of each unit and previous diagnosis results can be browsed. - To cancel self diagnosis midway, press the CANCEL key. - The results of the self diagnosis are stored as a log, and up to 10 logs can be confirmed from the 6.1.3 Transceiver log or 6.1.4 Controller/DTE log menu. - The self diagnosis results are printed out on the connected printer as the factory default setting. However note that the print format is selectable from Valid (the target name and the results of diagnosis items), Simple (the target name and the result), and Invalid (Not print) using the menu 6.1.1 Printout. - The self diagnosis test contents and results are as shown below. However note that if PA and/or ATU is in below freezing conditions, to avoid the failure of the moving part, the FAN is not checked and “-“(hyphen) is shown as the result. Maintenance & Inspection Unit Name Test Item ATU PA Transceiver TRX Contents :Serial communication :RBK interface :2140 kHz input value :2140 kHz tuning operation :4149 kHz input value :4149 kHz tuning operation :6230 kHz input value :6230 kHz tuning operation :8297 kHz input value :8297 kHz tuning operation :16546 kHz input value :16546 kHz tuning operation :25118 kHz input value :25118 kHz tuning operation :Air cooling fan operation :Confirmation of PA diagnosis viability RBK port :RBK overcurrent detection Memory1 :EEPROM1 operation Memory2 :EEPROM2 operation PA(A) voltage :PA (A) PS voltage PA(B) voltage :PA (B) PS voltage * DA output :2140 kHz output from DA PA(A) bias :PA (A) idling current PA(A) output :PA (A) output PA(B) bias :PA (B) idling current * PA(B) output :PA (B) output * PA(A)+(B) output :Combined PA output * LPF band1 output :2140kHz output LPF band2 output :3023kHz output LPF band3 output :4149kHz output LPF band4 output :6230kHz output LPF band5 output :8297kHz output LPF band6 output :12365kHz output LPF band7 output :16546kHz output LPF band8 output :25118kHz output Fan1 : Air cooling fan1 operation Fan2 : Air cooling fan2 operation * Fan3 : Air cooling fan3 operation Memory Digital CKT BK port PLL lock Serial I/F RBK port Band1 input Band1 tune Band2 input Band2 tune Band3 input Band3 tune Band4 input Band4 tune Band5 input Band5 tune Band6 input Band6 tune Fan PA mute port :EEPROM operation :FPGA operation :BK signal state :State of PLL for DDS/DUC clock Band1-TX output :1600 kHz output Band2-TX output :22000 kHz output Band3-TX output :27500 kHz output Band4-TX output :RX diagnosis circuit Band1-RX BPF1 :1600 kHz Rx level Band2-RX BPF2 :390 kHz Rx level Band3-RX BPF3 :1590 kHz Rx level Band4-RX BPF4 :3190 kHz Rx level Band5-RX BPF5 :6090 kHz Rx level Band6-RX BPF6 :10490 kHz Rx level Band7-RX BPF7 :17990 kHz Rx level Band8-RX BPF8 :27500 kHz Rx level Results OK: Normal NG: Abnormal OK: Normal NG: Abnormal * 500W model only OK: Normal NG: Abnormal 6-3 Maintenance & Inspection Transceiver (Cont’d) Unit Name WKR MODEM Memory1 Memory2 Memory3 PLL lock Band1-RX Band2-RX Band3-RX Band4-RX Band5-RX Band6-RX Band7-RX DSC/NBDP DSC/NBDP :FROM operation :EEPROM operation :SDRAM operation :State of PLL for DDS clock BPF1 :2187.5 kHz DSC loop BPF2 :4207.5 kHz DSC loop BPF3 :6312.0 kHz DSC loop BPF4 :8414.5 kHz DSC loop BPF5 :12577.0 kHz DSC loop BPF6 :16804.5 kHz DSC loop BPF7 :Wide-band filter operation loop1 :AF modem loop loop2 :AF modem & TRX loop Test Item Contents DGT CKT x Memory1 x Memory2 x Memory3 :FROM operation :EEPROM operation :SDRAM operation AF output AF connection to TRX OK: Normal NG: Abnormal Results OK: Normal NG: Abnormal OK: Normal NG: Abnormal Screen and ALM lamp display operation LCD&LED Note: Check visually if every dot and red and green ALM lamp alternately work normally for 3 seconds. DONE Sound test Speaker Controller/ Data terminal Note: Check if the 1500 Hz tone sounds correctly. After that, press ENT on the popup screen to finish this process. Print out test Printer DTE Note: When the printer is connected, check the print result in the printed data output. ・ DTE memory1 ・ DTE memory2 :FROM operation :SDRAM operation ・ DTE LCD&LED :Data terminal screen and lamp operation Note: Check visually if every dot alternating colors of red, green, blue and white with the lamp blink work normally for 5 seconds. ・ DTE buzzer Note: 6-4 DONE DONE OK: Normal NG: Abnormal DONE :DTE buzzer operation Check if the buzzer sounds correctly. After 3 seconds, sounding stops automatically DONE Maintenance & Inspection 6.3 System alarm indication This equipment displays alarms as follows when an internal or external error is detected. Alarm information PA PA Note :001,Overcurrent(A) :008,High-temp To return to the previous screen after the alarm is displayed, press the CANCEL key. When the TRX 024.PLL unlock or WKR MODEM 030.PLL unlock alarm is occurring, that mark remains as shown below until the equipment is restored to normal conditions. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL ITU- 401 RX 4357.0 kHz TX 4065.0 kHz SIG WKR scan bands: Unlock Unlock NonDST: DROBOS: EdtDST: 6-5 Maintenance & Inspection 6.3.1 Alarm list The following list shows the types of system alarms and contents when an alarm is detected on the equipment. (*) 500W model only Alarm Number Source Unit 001 PA Overcurrent (A) Detected an overcurrent (6.8A at AC, or 5.1A at DC) in the PA(A). Troubleshooting Procedure Re-tune or operate on another frequency. 002 PA Overload (A) Detected the condition SWR > 3 in the PA(A). Re-tune or operate on another frequency. 003 PA Overcurrent (B) * Detected an overcurrent (6.8A at AC, or 5.1A at DC) in the PA(B). Re-tune or operate on another frequency. 004 PA Overload (B) * Detected the condition SWR > 3 in the PA(B). Re-tune or operate on another frequency. 007 PA SWR/Overload Detected the condition SWR > 3 or overload at the PA output. Re-tune or operate on another frequency. 008 PA High-temp On TX, detected high temp (99°C or more) at the radiator in the PA unit. Stop transmission, or reduce output. 010 PA RBK overcurrent Detected RBK overcurrent. Please contact JRC or our agency. 011 PA High-VDD (A) 012 PA Low-VDD (A) 013 PA High-VDD (B) * 014 PA Low-VDD (B) * 066 PA DA high-temp 067 PA 068 Display Contents Detected overvoltage (132V or more) at the drain of the FET in the PA(A). Detected low voltage (80V or less) at the drain of the PA(A) FET. Detected overvoltage (132V or more) at the drain of the FET in the PA(B). Detected low voltage (80V or less) at the drain of the PA(B) FET. Detected high temperature (95°C or more) at the radiator of the DA. Please contact JRC or our agency. High-temp (A) Detected high temperature (99°C or more) at the radiator of the PA(A). Stop transmission, or reduce output. PA High-temp (B) * Detected high temperature (99°C or more) at the radiator of the PA(B). Stop transmission, or reduce output. 070 PA EEPROM (PA) Detected the PA memory error. Please contact JRC or our agency. 091 PA EEPROM (PACONT) Detected a memory error at the PA CONTROL UNIT. Please contact JRC or our agency. 071 PS PS for PA Detected abnormal condition (high temp/voltage) of the PS for PA. Please contact JRC or our agency. 017 ATU ATU lost Detected a serial communication error with the tuner. Please contact JRC or our agency. 018 ATU High voltage Detected a high voltage (3.5 kV or more) in antenna output. Re-tune, output. 019 ATU High-temp Detected an out-of-range temperature (70°C or more) inside the enclosure. Stop transmission, or reduce output. 072 ATU Overcurrent Detected antenna. Re-tune, output. 020 TRX DISP_KEY Detected abnormal ON signal at the PTT or Ext key of the controller. Please contact JRC or our agency. 021 TRX EXT_KEY Detected abnormal ON signal at the transceiver external key. Please contact JRC or our agency. 022 TRX SEL_BK Detected abnormal ON signal at the Selcall key on the transceiver. Please contact JRC or our agency. 023 TRX -BK Detected the -BK output during transmission. error Please contact JRC or our agency. 024 TRX PLL unlock Detected PLL unlock for the DDS or DUC clock. Please contact JRC or our agency. 030 WKR MODEM PLL unlock Detected PLL unlock for the DDS clock. Please contact JRC or our agency. 031 WKR MODEM MCDSP WDT Detected MCDSP malfunction. Please contact JRC or our agency. 032 WKR MODEM VDSP WDT Detected VDSP malfunction. Please contact JRC or our agency. 6-6 an overcurrent at the Please contact JRC or our agency. Please contact JRC or our agency. Please contact JRC or our agency. Stop transmission, or reduce output. or or reduce reduce Maintenance & Inspection 033 WKR MODEM MMSI lost Detected non-registration or loss of the ship's MMSI. Please contact JRC or our agency. 094 WKR MODEM Memory Detected a memory error. Please contact JRC or our agency. 035 Controller CTRL1 RBK OC Detected an overcurrent on the RBK circuit of controller 1. Please contact JRC or our agency. 036 Controller CTRL1 PTT Detected an error on the PTT control line of controller 1. Please contact JRC or our agency. 037 Controller CTRL1 CW KEY Detected an error on the CW key control line of controller 1. Please contact JRC or our agency. 038 Controller CTRL1 EXT KEY Detected an error on the external key control line of controller 1. Please contact JRC or our agency. 039 Controller CTRL2 RBK OC Detected an overcurrent on the RBK circuit of controller 2. Please contact JRC or our agency. 040 Controller CTRL2 PTT Detected an error on the PTT control line of controller 2. Please contact JRC or our agency. 041 Controller CTRL2 CW KEY Detected an error on the CW key control line of controller 2. Please contact JRC or our agency. 042 Controller CTRL2 EXT KEY Detected an error on the external key control line of controller 2. Please contact JRC or our agency. 047 Controller PA lost Detected a serial communication error with the PA. Please contact JRC or our agency. 048 Controller TRX lost Detected a serial communication error with the TRX. Please contact JRC or our agency. 050 Controller MODEM lost Detected a serial communication error with the WKR MODEM. Please contact JRC or our agency. 051 Controller CTRL1 lost Detected a serial communication error with the No.1 controller. Please contact JRC or our agency. 052 Controller CTRL2 lost Detected a serial communication error with the No.2 controller. Please contact JRC or our agency. 095 Controller CTRL1 memory Detected a memory error on the No.1 controller. Please contact JRC or our agency. 096 Controller CTRL2 memory Detected a memory error on the No.2 controller. Please contact JRC or our agency. 059 Data terminal My/OTH DTE lost 060 Data terminal My/OTH DTE lost 062 Data terminal My/OTH DTE USB-IC 063 Data terminal My/OTH DTE USB-IC Detected a serial communication error between controller (ID:1) and DTE. Note) My or OTH indicates the relationship between that data terminal and the controller displaying this alarm. Detected a serial communication error between controller (ID:2) and DTE. Note) My or OTH indicates the relationship between that data terminal and the controller displaying this alarm. Detected the SPI communication error at the USB circuit of the data terminal connected to the controller (ID:1). Note) My or OTH indicates the relationship between that data terminal and the controller displaying this alarm. Detected the SPI communication error at the USB circuit of the data terminal connected to the controller (ID:2). Note) My or OTH indicates the relationship between that data terminal and the controller displaying this alarm. Check the data terminal cable connection, or the condition of the data terminal. Check the data terminal cable connection, or the condition of the data terminal. Please contact JRC or our agency. Please contact JRC or our agency. 6-7 Maintenance & Inspection Also, the following alarms are displayed when an error is detected just after turning on the equipment. Please notify JRC or our agency of the details of the alarm. Display Detected this controller's barcode number lost! So required to replace the CONTROL UNIT in it with the new one. Detected this controller's SIO error! So required initial set after restarting as the maintenance mode. Detected this controller's address setting error! So required initial set after restarting as the maintenance mode. Detected MMSI lost! So concerned DSC functions no longer available now. Detected PA UNIT lost or this controller's SIO error! So required initial set after restarting as the maintenance mode. Detected TRX UNIT lost! So concerned all functions no longer available now. 6-8 Contents Detected an error in the barcode number on the controller. Detected a communication error between controller and transceiver at startup. Detected this controller's starting the controller. address error the when Unregistered MMSI, or lost the MMSI. Detected malfunction of the PA communication error on the controller. Detected TRX unit malfunction. unit or Maintenance & Inspection 6.3.2 Viewing the alarm history The following describes how to view alarm information detected by the equipment or a history of past occurring alarms in the 6.2 Alarm information menu. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Press the MENU key, and through hierarchical menus, select 6.2 Alarm information. One of the screens shown at right is displayed indicating if an alarm is occurring . 6.2)Alarm information No data Press ENT to view alarm history. (If there is no alarm) 6.2)Alarm information Note The displayed alarm information is formatted as follows. PA PA :001,Overcurrent(A) :008,High-temp [Unit Name] : [Alarm Number], [Information] Press ENT to view alarm history. (If there is an alarm) 22.. To check the alarm history, press ENT. The popup screen at right is displayed, select OK. 6.2)Alarm information View alarm history? No data [ OK ] [Cancel] Press ENT to view alarm history. 33.. The alarm history is displayed. Up to 100 of the latest histories are stored. If necessary, scroll with the jog dial. Note The displayed alarm history is formatted as follows. Alarm history 1.2008-12-31 23:59 A PA :001,Overcurrent(A) 2.2008-12-31 23:59 A PA :008,High-temp 3.2008-11-30 22:45 V ATU :019,High-temp 4.2008-11-28 22:11 V ATU :018,High voltage [Number] [Alarm & recovery time] [A: Alarm/V: Recovery] [Unit name] : [Alarm number], [Information] 6-9 Maintenance & Inspection 6.4 Software version ■ Procedure ■ To view the version of the software currently running on the equipment, press the MENU key, and display 6.3 Software version in the menu list. ¾ Each software version of the transceiver, the controller and the data terminal is displayed as shown at right. ¾ Besides above, the software version of the data terminal is displayed through the Help menu. 6-10 6.3)Software version - Controller - WKR MODEM - TRX - PA - ATU - DTE 0.Back :05.00 :03.00 :01.00 :01.00 :01.00 :01.00 Maintenance & Inspection 6.5 Troubleshooting WARNING This equipment is used for both distress communication and routine communication. Contact JRC or our agent if any problem is observed in this unit during routine operation or inspection. Do not open the equipment to inspect or repair internal circuits. Inspection or repairs by anyone other than a specialized technician may result in fire, electrical shock, or malfunction. If internal inspection or repair is necessary, contact our service center or agents. 6.5.1 Procedures for locating malfunctions 1) 2) First, check the power supply voltage and connectors. If there are no problems with the above, use a tester to check for errors. The following table shows the instruments required for performing repairs and the severity of malfunctions. If the user is to locate the malfunction himself, perform only No. 1 and No. 2. No. Type of Malfunction Examples Faulty connector contacts Broken antenna cables Defective switches, controls, etc. Other problems that can be visually detected Faults requiring no instrument to locate ・ ・ ・ ・ Malfunctions that can be discovered and repaired with a tester ・ Confirmation of power supply voltage ・ Breaks in external wiring Malfunctions requiring special instrument ・ Fan malfunction in transceiver and ATU enclosure fan ・ Crystal oscillator frequency deviation ・ Decrease in transmitting power and reception sensitivity ・ Decrease in transmitter modulation level ・ Malfunction in semiconductors, ICs, and similar devices 6-11 Maintenance & Inspection 6.5.2 Guide to locating faults Use the following table as a guide to locating the causes of malfunctions in the equipment. Also, when contacting JRC or our agency, please notify us of the malfunction conditions. No. Symptom Typical causes Nothing is displayed on the controller or the data terminal screen. x Malfunction in the controller or data terminal cable x Abnormal power supply voltage x Malfunction in the power switch, display circuit or control circuit TX and ON is displayed but no voice is transmitted in the TEL mode. x Malfunction in the handset x Malfunction in the controller cable x Malfunction in the AF signal transmission circuit TX is displayed but ON is not, and transmission is not possible. x Malfunction in the transmission circuit TX and ON are displayed, and transmission is not possible. x Malfunction in the handset PTT switch (TEL mode) x Malfunction in the electrical key connection (CW mode) x Malfunction in the transmission circuit Reception sensitivity is poor. Little or no sound from the speaker, both static and voices. x Malfunction in the speaker x Malfunction in the receiver circuit Radio static (noise) is output from the speaker, but cannot receive transmissions from other stations. Note Antenna damage Break or short circuit of antenna cable Malfunction in the antenna connectors Malfunction in the receiver circuit Antenna damage Break or short circuit of antenna cable Malfunction in the antenna connectors Malfunction in the receiver The following are not faults. Symptom Possible Causes Handling Both Tx & Rx functions are invalid, and the SIG meter indicates off-the-scale. The external BK line is ON. Stop operating the external equipment. The VOL control, the dimmer, and PWR key on the controller are valid but functions such as the RF GAIN control are invalid. Multiple controllers are connected, and another controller has access rights. Press ENT to obtain access rights, and after that, retry the operation. No response from other station via radiotelephone or DSC call. No operator in that station, or unavailable to respond due to other duties. Wait and retry later. When multiple controllers are connected, access rights cannot be obtained by pressing ENT on a monitor controller. Another controller with higher priority is in use for communicating or is performing menu operations. After operations on the other controller are finished, obtain access rights. If the system is left on a screen other than the status display for a while, the screen returns to the status display. The inactivity timer is activated and the menu is closed. Set the timer with the 7.3.6 Menu shutdown. The received distress call log has been erased without operation. Automatically deleted the received distress calls of 48 hours old after that reception. (IMO A.806(19)) Or the equipment had been turned off by such as the breaker on the power supply. Print and save received messages if necessary. When turning on the data terminal, the start screen is displayed. But after that, nothing is displayed. The dimmer level is adjusted to 0 with such as Ctrl+È operation. 6-12 Adjust the dimmer level with the DIM key on the panel of the data terminal or Ctrl+Ç operation. Maintenance & Inspection 6.5.3 Consumables The following shows consumables. Please contact JRC or our agency to order parts. Location Description Model (Part number) NKG-91 PRINTER Printer paper 7ZPJD0384 DPU-414 PRINTER Printer paper 6ZCAF00252A Printer paper 5ZPCM00020 Ink ribbon (SP-16051) 5ZZCM00003 Replacement Guide Indicating red paper edge mark on the NKG-800 PRINTER 6.5.4 When print becomes light Repair units/parts The repair units and replacement part units are as follows. NTD-2250/ 2500 TRANSCEIVER Description Model (Part number) Notes PA CONTROL UNIT CMC-2425/ 2450 PA UNIT CAH-2425/ 2450 LPF UNIT CFJ-2425/ 2450 EXTERNAL UNIT CQD-2419 Common for 250W and 500W TRX UNIT CMN-2250 Common for 250W and 500W WKR MODEM UNIT CMJ-2250 Common for 250W and 500W NBD-2250/ 2500 POWER SUPPLY Description Model (Part number) Notes DC_DC UNIT CBG-2415 Common for 250W and 500W PA_PS UNIT CBG-2416 Common for 250W and 500W Note) 2pcs for 500W FILTER UNIT CBL-2415 Common for 250W and 500W Air filter MTZ304438A Everlight scott filter NCM-2150 MF/HF CONTROLLER Description Model (Part number) CONTROL UNIT CDJ-3775 AF CONT UNIT CMV-3775 LCD UNIT CDE-3770 MAIN PANEL UNIT CCK-3775 SUB PANEL UNIT CCK-3776 SPEAKER 7USJD0007 CONTROLLER CABLE 7ZCJD0343 Notes Control cable (5 m) 6-13 Maintenance & Inspection NFC-2250/ 2500 ANTENNA TUNER Description Model (Part number) Notes MATCHING UNIT CFG-2250 For 250W only MATCHING A UNIT CFG-2500 For 500W only MATCHING B UNIT CFG-2503 For 500W only ANT SW UNIT CSD-2250/ 2500 TUNER CONT CDJ-2525 NDZ-227 DATA TERMINAL Description Model (Part number) PROCESS CIRCUIT CDC-1346B INTERFACE UNIT CMH-3227 COLOR LCD UNIT CCN-3227 LCD I/F UNIT CQC-1262 USB I/F UNIT CQD-3227 Notes 10.4 inch NBB-714 BATTERY CHARGER Description Model (Part number) AC fuse 7ZFJD0002 NBB714_Dustfilter NBB714-FIL NBB714_Fan NBB714-FAN Common for 250W and 500W Notes 10A NBB-724 BATTERY CHARGER Description Model (Part number) NBB724_Dustfilter NBB724-FIL NBB724_Fan NBB724-FAN 6.5.5 Notes Regular replacement parts The following shows parts that need to be replaced regularly. Please contact JRC or our agency to order parts. Description Model (Part number) Replacement Period Cooling fan for PA and PS 7BZJD0006 Approx. 50,000 hours of use at room temperature Cooling fan for ATU 7BZJD0008 Approx. 50,000 hours of use at room temperature LCD unit for controller CDE-3770 Approx. 20,000 hours of continued use at maximum brightness LCD unit for data terminal CCN-3227 Approx. 50,000 hours of continued use at maximum brightness 6-14 After-Sales Service 7. AFTER-SALES SERVICE ★ Warranty The warranty period is determined by JRC's warranty regulations, but is normally 1 year from the date of purchase. Additionally, the warranty except for the body text is submitted to contractual agreements. ★ Repair Part Inventory Period Parts necessary for proper functioning of this equipment will be kept available for 10 years after product discontinuation. ★ When Requesting Repairs If what appears to be a defect is detected, refer to "6.5 Troubleshooting" to check if the equipment is actually defective. If the problem is due to a defect, immediately stop use of the system and contact the store where you purchased the system, or one of our branches. During the warranty period , if a malfunction occurs with the equipment while in standard usage in accordance with this instruction manual, we or our agencies will repair the malfunction at no charge at the store where the equipment was purchased or another location specified by JRC. If the malfunction occurs due to improper usage, fault (including the use of the virusinfected USB flash memory), or any external abnormal condition such as fire, pollution, abnormal voltage, natural disaster (ex. thunder storms, earthquake) etc., JRC will repair the equipment for a fee. Furthermore, regardless of the warranty period, orders of consumables will be charged. After the warranty expires , we will repair the malfunction for a fee, if repair is possible. Please inform us of the following : ☆ Product name, model name, manufactured date, serial number ☆ As much information as you can provide about the malfunction (alarm number, whether transmission is possible or not, etc.) ☆ Your company or organization name, address, and phone number ★ Periodical Maintenance Recommendation Depending on the usage conditions, with extended use, the performance of this equipment may degrade over time, and externally installed parts such as the antenna may degrade due to vibration, so we recommend periodical maintenance in addition to the standard maintenance. Please contact the store where you purchased the equipment, or one of our branches, to request periodical maintenance. Periodical maintenance requires a service charge. If you have any questions regarding after-sales service, please contact the store where you purchased the equipment, or one of our branches. Refer to the inside of the back cover for contact numbers and locations. 7-1 Disposal 8. DISPOSAL Observe all rules and regulations of the local authorities when disposing of this equipment. 8-1 Specifications 9. SPECIFICATIONS 9.1 JSS-2250/2500 MF/HF Radio Equipment General Specifications Transmission frequency Reception frequency Frequency stability Type of emission Channels Scan channels Nominal frequency Communication method in TEL Antenna impedance Channel switching duration Interface Compass safety distance Main controls Performance criteria 1605.0 - 27500.0 kHz (100 Hz steps) 90.0 - 29999.9 kHz (100 Hz steps) Within ±10 Hz TEL mode : J3E DSC/TLX mode : F1B CW mode : A1A AM mode : H3E H2B mode : H2B DATA mode : J2D User channels (TEL/DSC/CW) : Max. 400 ch (20 ch x 20 grp) User channels (TLX) : Max. 400 ch (20 ch x 20 sta) ITU preset channels : 1722 ch Max. 20 channels (group specification method) J3E/ A1A/ H3E/ H2B/ J2D : Carrier frequencies F1B : Assigned frequency Push-to-talk (simplex, semi-duplex) 50Ω unbalanced 15 sec or less IEC61162-1 (GPS/AME/RMS) 2.0 m DSC call (sending and receiving), communication freq/ channel settings, Tx power settings, RF gain adjustment, volume adjustment, LCD adjustment Continuous operation (TEL) Continuous operation (DSC,WKR) Category type of the weather resistance Protection rating Dimensions and mass (approx) IMO A.806(19), A.694(17), MSC68(68), MSC/Circ.862 IEC 60945 Ed.4 2002-08 90 VAC to 132 VAC, 180 VAC to 264 VAC 24 VDC (21.6 VDC to 31.2 VDC) AC : 2kVA / 3kVA Transmission 24VDC : 40A / 40A Reception AC : 0.5kVA / 0.5kVA 24VDC : 6A / 6A -30 to +55 o C (-15 to +55 o C during normal operation) -30 to +55°C (parts exposed to condensation -30 to +70°C) No abnormality after standing 10 hours in +40°C, 93%RH 2 Hz - 5 Hz to 13.2 Hz : Full amplitude ±1 mm±10% 13.2 Hz to 100 Hz : Max acceleration 7 m/s fixed No abnormality after testing resonance points or at 30 Hz for 2 hours No abnormality after operating continuously for 8 hours No abnormality after operating continuously for 24 hours Antenna tuner and the junction box : Exposed Other units : Protected IP22 equivalent (controller panel) Main unit (Incase of the NCU-515A Rack) (JSS-2250/ 2500) 520mm(W) x 665mm(H) x 450mm(D) [ex. projections], 90kg/96kg Power supply voltage Current consumption (JSS-2250/ 2500) Operating temperature range Storage temperature range Humidity resistance Vibration resistance (3 axes) Antenna tuner 395mm(W) x 622mm(H) x 198mm(D) [ex. projections], 10kg/10kg MF/HF controller 230mm(W) x 142mm(H) x 89mm(D) [ex. projections], 1.3kg Data terminal 336mm(W) x 244mm(H) x 88mm(D) [ex. projections], 4.6kg 9-1 Specifications Transmitter Antenna output power (JSS-2250/ 2500) Modulation method Occupied bandwidth Carrier suppression (J3E) Unwanted emissions in the out-of-band domain AC : 200Wpep / 400Wpep 24VDC : 100Wpep / 100Wpep AC : 250Wpep / 500Wpep 24VDC : 150Wpep / 150Wpep Low-power stage balanced modulation J3E/ J2D/ H2B : Within 3 kHz F1B/ A1A : Within 0.5 kHz 40 dB or more Mean power of 50 mW or lower, or 67/70 dB or more lower than the mean power of the basic frequency 1605.0 - 3999.9 kHz 4000.0 - 27500.0 kHz (JSS-2250/ 2500) Unwanted emissions in the spurious domain JSS-2250/2500 At J3E: 1.5 to 4.5 kHz 4.5 to 7.5 kHz 7.5 kHz and upwards At F1B: 0.25 to 0.5 kHz 0.50 to 1.25 kHz 1.25 kHz and upwards : 28/28 dB or more : 35/35 dB or more : 64/67 dB or more : 28/28 dB or more : 35/35 dB or more : 67/70 dB or more And following Attenuation [dB] Mistuned frequency [Hz] Overall distortion and noise AF frequency response Tone frequency Receiver Receiving system 1st IF 2nd IF Reception frequency stability Sensitivity (SINAD 20dB) Pass band/Adjacent signal selectivity Spurious response Blocking/Desensitization 9-2 -20 dB or less Deviation is within 6 dB in 350 Hz to 2700 Hz range. 1500 Hz or 1400 Hz Double superheterodyne 70.036 MHz 36 kHz Within ±10 Hz J3E : 2.5 uV or less (1605.0 to 27500.0 kHz) F1B : 0.7 uV or less (1605.0 to 27500.0 kHz) A1A : 1.4 uV or less (1605.0 to 27500.0 kHz) J3E : 2.4 - 3.0 kHz (6 dB bandwidth) within ±2.1 kHz (66 dB bandwidth) F1B : 270 - 300Hz (6 dB bandwidth) within ±550 Hz (60 dB bandwidth) J3E : 60 dB or more F1B : Symbol error rate of 1% or better at a wanted signal level of 10 uV and an unwanted signal level of 31.6 mV separated by 750 Hz J3E : When an unwanted signal level separated by 3 kHz is added to the wanted signal level of 10 uV, the unwanted signal input voltage suppressing output of the wanted signal by 3 dB is 10 mV or more. F1B : Symbol error rate of 1% or better at a wanted signal level of 10 uV and an unwanted signal level of 1 mV separated by 500 Hz Specifications Overall distortion and noise Conducted spurious emission Clarifier variable range Antenna impedance Line output When an input signal level of 30 uV is applied, the ratio between low-frequency output 1000 Hz and unwanted components contained in that output is 30 dB or more. Power emitted from antenna terminal is 2 nW or less (9kHz - 2GHz) and 20 nW or less (2GHz - 4GHz). ±200 Hz (1 Hz steps) 50Ω unbalanced 0 dBm 600Ω (balanced) DSC Watch Keeping Receiver Reception frequency Distress and safety frequencies of 2187.5 kHz and 8414.5 kHz, and additionally on one or more of the 4207.5 kHz/ 6312.0 kHz/ 12577.0 kHz/ 16804.5 kHz Receiving system Double superheterodyne 1st IF 40.04025 MHz 2nd IF 40.25 kHz Frequency stability Within ±10 Hz Sensitivity 1% or lower symbol error rate at reception input voltage of 1µV Passband 6 dB bandwidth : 270 - 300 Hz 30 dB bandwidth : Within ±380 Hz 60 dB bandwidth : Within ±550 Hz Spurious response Symbol error rate of 1% or better when an unwanted signal level of 31.6 mV is applied to a wanted signal level of 10 uv from an intermediate frequency separated by 750 Hz or more through to a frequency 3x the test frequency Blocking/Desensitization Symbol error rate of 1% or better at a wanted signal level of 10 uV and an unwanted signal level of 1 mV separated by 500 Hz Conducted spurious emission Power emitted from antenna terminal is 2 nW or less. Antenna impedance 50Ω unbalanced DSC Modem Modulation rate Modulation method Mark frequency (Y) Space frequency (B) DSC Protocol DSC operation standards DSC code Message storage NBDP Modem Modulation rate Modulation method Mark frequency (Y) Space frequency (B) NBDP Protocol Within 100 baud ±30x 10 - 6 FSK (sub-carrier: 1700 Hz) Transmission : Within 1615 Hz ±0.5 Hz Reception (permissible value) : Within 1615 Hz ±20 Hz Transmission : Within 1785 Hz ±0.5 Hz Reception (permissible value) : Within 1785 Hz ±20 Hz ITU-R recommendation M.493-13 (Class A and B) ITU-R recommendation M.541-9, M.821-1 10-bit error detecting code 20 Rx distress, 20 Rx others, 20 Tx messages Within 100baud ±30x 10 -6 以内 FSK ( sub-carrier: 1700Hz) Transmission Reception (permissible value) : Transmission Reception (permissible value) : Within Within Within Within 1615 1615 1785 1785 Hz Hz Hz Hz ±0.5 Hz ±20 Hz ±0.5 Hz ±20 Hz ITU-R recommendation M.476-5,M.491-1,M.492-6,M.625-4 ITU-T recommendation F.1, F.130, S.6 NBDP code 7-bit error detecting code 9-3 Specifications Antenna tuner Frequency range Maximum input power 1605.0 - 27500.0 kHz 1605.0 - 3999.9 kHz 250Wpep / 500Wpep (JSS-2250/ 2500) 4000.0 - 27500.0 kHz 300Wpep / 700Wpep SWR after tuning Tuning method Tuning time Power supply 2:1 or less Preset or auto-tuning Preset tuning: 0.5 seconds, auto-tuning: max. 45 seconds 24 VDC (21.6 VDC to 24.7 VDC) MF/HF controller Communication speed Communication interface Microphone input impedance Standard modulation input Audio output LCD display Data terminal Communication speed 57.6 kbps RS-485 and RS-232C, and Centronics compliant 150Ω balanced -54 dBm Internal loud speaker (8Ω) : 5W max External speaker impedance : 8Ω or more Handset phone (150Ω) : Rated 1mW or more 3.8 inch FSTN monochrome, 320 x 240 dot, LED backlight 4.8kbps Communication interface RS-232C USB interface USB 2.0, FAT16/32 file format Keyboard interface PS/2 Printer interface Centronics compliant LCD display 10.4 inch TFT color, 640x480 dots, CCFL backlight Standard brightness 450cd/m , Viewing angle 160 ゚/140 ゚ Contrast ● 600: 1 Keyboard Communication interface Serial two wire interactive transmission Connector Mini DIN 5Pin Durability 20,000,000 times ● Printer (NKG-800/NKG-900) Printing system Communication interface Supported fonts Paper feed system Paper type Buffer size Density adjustment Power supply voltage Power consumption 9-4 Serial impact dot matrix Centronics compliant ANK FX850 mode 324 characters IBM Proprinter II mode 264 characters Roll paper holder 209 - 216 mm (8.23 - 8.50") roll paper ANK FX850 mode 21 kbytes IBM Proprinter II mode 9.3 kbytes Manual (non-stepped) 10.2 VDC - 31.2 VDC Maximum 35 W Specifications 9.2 Options (1) Battery charger (NBB-714) Source voltage Current consumption Charging current Charging circuit/ characteristic 90 VAC to 132 VAC or 180 VAC to 264 VAC (50/60 Hz) Charging : 8 A or less (100 VAC input) 4 A or less (220 VAC input) Discharging : 0.3 A or less (at 24 VDC ope) Maximum 10 A Floating charge 16 VDC or more: Constant voltage or current characteristic Less than 16 VDC: Reduced current characteristic* (*) Foldback current limiting characteristic Functions Alarm type Temperature range for full performance Operating temperature range Storage temperature range Humidity resistance Vibration resistance (3 axes) (2) Battery charger (NBB-724) Source voltage Current consumption Charging current Charging circuit/ characteristic Overvoltage input protection, Reverse polarity protection, Dimmer lamp, Alarm mute with remote control Batt low/high voltage, Internal temperature, AC fail, Other abnormal charging -15°C - +55°C -15°C - +55°C -25°C - +65°C No abnormality after standing 10 hours in +40°C, 93% RH 2 Hz - 5 Hz to 13.2 Hz: : Full amplitude ±1 mm±10% 13.2 Hz to 100 Hz: : Maximum acceleration m/s fixed No abnormality after testing resonance points or at 30 Hz for more than 2 hours 90 VAC to 132 VAC or 180 VAC to 264 VAC (50/60 Hz) Charging : 15 A or less (100 VAC input) 8 A or less (220 VAC input) Discharging : 0.5 A or less (at 24 VDC ope) Maximum 22 A (Common to Floating & Equalizing charge) Floating charge and equalizing charge 18 VDC or more: Constant voltage or current characteristic Less than 18 VDC: Reduced current characteristic* (*) Foldback current limiting characteristic Functions Alarm type Temperature range for full performance Operating temperature range Storage temperature range Humidity resistance Vibration resistance (3 axes) Overvoltage input protection, Reverse polarity protection, Dimmer lamp, Float/Equal changing, DC ope, Batt temp Batt low/high voltage, Internal temperature, Other abnormal charging -15°C - +55°C -15°C - +55°C -25°C - +65°C No abnormality after standing 10 hours in +40°C, 93% RH 2 Hz - 5 Hz to 13.2 Hz: : Full amplitude ±1 mm±10% 13.2 Hz to 100 Hz: : Maximum acceleration m/s fixed No abnormality after testing resonance points or at 30 Hz for more than 2 hours 9-5 Specifications (3) Printer (NKG-91) Printing system Communication interface Data control Data buffer Maximum print speed Roll paper width Power supply voltage Current consumption Thermal line dot RS-232C, 4.8/9.6/38.4 kbps RTS/CTS 4096 byte 20 mm/sec or more 58 mm 6.5 VDC (5 VDC to 8.7 VDC) Maximum 2 A (4) Printer (DPU-414) Printing system Communication interface Data control Data buffer Maximum print speed Roll paper width Power voltage Current consumption Thermal serial dot RS-232C, 4.8k/9.6k/38.4 kbps HW busy About 28 Kbyte 52.5 cps 112 mm 6.5 VDC Maximum 2 A 9-6 Specifications 9.3 Peripheral interfaces (1) GPS or other navigation aid interface Interface standard NMEA0183/ IEC61162-1 Ed.4 (2010-11) compliant Protocol 4800 bps, start 1 bit, data 8 bit, stop 1 bit Non parity NMEA0183 Input sentence V1.5: V2.0: V2.3: (Talker = "GP" or other) GGA/ GLL/ RMC GGA/ GLL/ RMC/ ZDA GGA/ GLL/ RMC/ GNS/ ZDA Data type Ship position & time information: GGA/ GNS/ GLL/ RMC Date information: ZDA/ RMC Equipment time information: ZDA/ GGA/ GNS/ GLL/ RMC (1.1) Electrical description CQD-2417 TERMINAL BOARD CMC-2425/2450 PA CONTROL UNIT CMN-2250 TRX UNIT CMJ-2250 WKR MODEM UNIT TR501 TB204 GPS_RX-A 26 GPS_RX-B 27 J202 J102 J172 W30 J1111 W13 J1131 W14 R542 J502 R541 TR502 R543 R544 R541, R543: 270 R542, R544: 10k ■ +3.3V R540 3.3k CD503 PHT501 Load requirements Current consumption : 2mA at 2V or less Maximum input voltage : ±15V or more Recommended operating current : 2mA or more 9-7 Specifications (1.2) List of sentences and associated data fields (1.2.1) GGA – Global positioning system (GPS) fix data $--GGA, hhmmss, llll.ll, a, yyyyy.yy, a, x, xx, x.x, x.x, M, x.x, M, x.x, xxxx *hh Differential reference station ID, 0000-1023 Age of differential GPS data Units of geoidal separation, m Geoidal separation Units of antenna altitude, m Antenna altitude above/below mean sea level (geoid) Horizontal dilution of precision Number of satellites in use, 00-12, may be different from the number in view GPS quality indicator Longitude E/W Latitude N/S UTC of position (1.2.2) GLL – Geographic position – Latitude/longitude $--GLL, llll.ll, a, yyyyy.yy, a, hhmmss.ss, A, a *hh Mode indicator: A = Autonomous, D = Differential, E = Estimated M = Manual input, S = Simulator, N = Data not valid Status: A= data valid, V= data invalid UTC of position Longitude, E/W Latitude, N/S 9-8 Specifications (1.2.3) RMC – Recommended minimum specific GNSS data $--RMC, hhmmss.ss, A, llll.ll, a, yyyyy.yy, a, x.x, x.x, xxxxxx, x.x, a, a, a *hh Navigational status Mode indicator: A = Autonomous, D = Differential, E = Estimated, F = Float RTK, M = Manual input, N = Data not valid P = Precise, R = Real Time Kinematic S = Simulator, Magnetic variation, degrees, E/W Date: dd/mm/yy Course over ground, degrees true Speed over ground, knots Longitude, E/W Latitude, N/S Status: A = data valid, V = navigation receiver warning UTC of position fix (1.2.4) GNS – GNSS fix data $--GNS, hhmmss.ss, llll.ll, a, yyyyy.yy, a, c---c, xx, x.x, x.x, x.x, x.x, x.x, a *hh Navigational status Differential reference station ID Age of differential data Geoidal separation, m Antenna altitude, m, re: mean-sea-level (geoid) HDOP Total number of satellites in use, 00-99 Mode indicator: N = No fix, A = Autonomous, D = Differential, P = Precise, R = Real Time Kinematic, F = Float RTK, E = Estimated, M = Manual input, S = Simulator Longitude, E/W Latitude, N/S UTC of position 9-9 Specifications (1.2.5) ZDA – Time and date $--ZDA, hhmmss.ss, xx, xx, xxxx, xx, xx *hh Local zone minutes, 00 to +59 Local zone hours, 00 h to ±13 h Year (UTC) Month, 01 to 12 (UTC) Day, 01 to 31 (UTC) UTC (2) RMS interface Interface standard IEC61162-1 compliant Protocol 4800 bps, start 1 bit, data 8 bit, stop 1 bit Non parity Output message IEC61162-1 compliant proprietary sentence $PJRCL sentence (for RMS log saving) $PJRCM sentence (Device ID = "CT") Data type Model number, serial number, self-diagnosis information, etc. 9-10 Options Operation 10. OPTIONS OPERATION 10.1 Battery charger (NBB-714) CAUTION When replacing fuses, always use fuses of the same type. 7 9 10 1. 10A fuse ························ AC mains fuses (2pcs) 2. AC switch ······················ Turns on the AC mains power supply. 3. BATT LOW/HIGH lamp ···· This lamp turns on and the buzzer sounds to indicate low voltage of the battery (approx. 21.5V). And also turns on and the buzzer sounds to indicate overvoltage of the battery (approx. 32.2 ~ 37.0V) and then, turns off the BATT breaker. 4. AC FAIL/ CHG ALARM ···· This lamp turns on and the buzzer sounds to indicate any one of the following alarms. ・ While the BATT breaker is ON, the AC switch is OFF or any AC fails such as the power failure or the blowout of fuses. ・ While the AC switch is ON, the BATT breaker is OFF. ・ Over discharge detection (16V or less) Note) If AC input is ON, charging is available without tripping the breaker. ・ Overheat detection (+80C) 5. Current meter ················ Indicates the charge current (+) or discharge current (-). 6. ALM MUTE switch ·········· Silences the active alarm buzzer sound. 7. Alarm buzzer 8. Voltage meter ················ Indicates the output voltage of the battery. 9. Dimmer control ·············· Adjusts the dimmer level of alarm lamps. Note) Unable to turn off completely. 10. BATT breaker ················· When turned on, connects the internal circuit to the battery, and after that turning on the AC breaker enables charging of the battery. Note that if detected over discharge of the battery (approx. 19.5V), this breaker trips automatically. 10-1 Options Operation ■ Procedure ■ Turn on the AC switch and the BATT breaker to start charging the battery. ¾ The AC FAIL/CHG ALARM is activated if the AC switch and BATT breaker are turned ON at different timing. However it is due to the notification function of the switch/breaker ON/OFF state and is NOT the alarm for any malfunction. ¾ The NBB-714 is a battery charger for the maintenance free battery only, i.e. the charging type is floating only and not providing the equalizing charge. ■ Replacing fuses ■ To replace fuses, turn off the AC switch and the BATT breaker first, and then unscrew the both two fuse cases as shown below to replace them. Note Note) The appearance of the blowout fuses look like normal. So when checking if the fuses are blown or not, always use the tester. ・ The battery can be used as a secondary power source when the BATT breaker is ON while the AC breaker is OFF. However in this case, be sure not to cause over discharge condition. ・ When any alarm is occurred, treat it as follows. - BATT HIGH ······················ - BATT LOW ······················· - AC FAIL/CHG ALARM ········· - High temperature ·············· 10-2 When the battery overvoltage (32.2~37.0V) is detected, trips the BATT breaker. In this case, turn off the AC switch. And then, after the voltage is recovered to normal, turn on the AC switch and the BATT breaker. Note) In this case, the charge alarm is also detected due to the BATT breaker trip and the CHG ALARM is activated. Carry on charging. This alarm is cleared automatically after the battery voltage increases to approx. 23.5V. - Turn on the AC input/switch. - After checking that the battery voltage is not overvoltage, turn on the BATT breaker. - If the battery is over discharge condition (16V), turn on both the AC switch and the BATT breaker to charge the battery. The built-in charging circuit is disconnected until the temperature returns to the normal condition (60℃ or lower) automatically Options Operation 10.2 Battery charger (NBB-724) CAUTION The batteries, except for sealed lead-acid batteries that require no equalization, should be carried out the equalizing charge at least every six months 10 1. AC breaker ·················· When turned on, enables to use the AC mains input. 2. BATT breaker ··············· When turned on, connects the internal circuit to the battery, and after that turning on the AC breaker enables charging of the battery. Note that if detected over discharge of the battery (approx. 19.5V), this breaker trips automatically. 3. BATT LOW alarm lamp ··· This lamp turns on and the buzzer sounds to indicate low voltage of the battery (approx. 21.5V). 4. CHG alarm lamp ·········· This lamp turns on (or blinks*) and the buzzer sounds to indicate any one of the following alarms. ・ The BATT breaker is OFF while the AC breaker is ON. ・ Over voltage (equalizing charge voltage + 1.0V) ・ High temperature of the charging circuit (+75℃ ) * 5. FLOAT charge lamp ······ This lamp turns on during the floating charge operation. 6. EQUAL charge lamp ····· This lamp turns on during the equalizing charge operation. 7. CHARGE mode switch ···· 8. Dimmer control ············ Adjusts the dimmer level. 9. Current meter ·············· Indicates the charge current (+) or discharge current (-). 10. Voltage meter ·············· Changes the charge mode between floating and equalizing charge. Indicates the output voltage of the battery. 10-3 Options Operation (1) Charging a battery in the floating mode ■ Procedure ■ Turn on the AC and BATT breakers. ¾ FLOAT lamp turns on during the floating charge operation. ¾ When turning on the AC breaker prior to BATT breaker, CHG alarm lamp turns on and the buzzer sounds. But this is not malfunction as mentioned above. (2) Charging a battery in the equalizing mode ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Turn on the AC and BATT breakers. Make sure FLOAT lamp is turned on and the battery charge is started in the floating mode. 22.. Press the CHARGE mode switch. ¾ The lighting lamp is changed from FLOAT to EQUAL to indicate operating in the equalizing mode. ¾ The charging mode can be switched between FLOAT and EQUAL alternately. 33.. When the equalizing charge is completed, returns to the floating mode automatically. The equalizing charge is continued until the charge current goes down to approx. 3.0A or until 10 hours elapse. Note ・ The battery can be used as a secondary power source when the BATT breaker is ON while the AC breaker is OFF. However in this case, be sure not to cause over discharge condition. ・ When any alarm is occurred, treat it as follows. - BATT LOW ················ Carry on charging. This alarm is cleared automatically after the battery voltage increases to approx. 23.5V. - BATT breaker OFF ····· Turn the BATT breaker on. - Over voltage ············· Turn off the AC and BATT breakers until the battery voltage returns to the normal condition. - High temperature ······· The built-in charging circuit is disconnected until the temperature returns to the normal condition (60 ℃ or lower) automatically - Over discharge ·········· When the BATT breaker trips, turn on the breakers in the order of AC and BATT so that the charge operation is restarted. 10-4 Options Operation 10.3 Printer (NKG-91) CAUTION The thermal head of the NKG-91 printer may be very hot after printing. Do not touch the thermal head of the printer. Make sure that the thermal head is cool before replacing the paper or cleaning the thermal head. The paper used in the NKG-91 printer is heat sensitive. Take the following precautions when using this paper. ・ Store the paper away from heat, humidity, or heat sources. ・ Do not rub the paper with any hard objects. ・ Do not place the paper near organic solvents. ・ Do not allow the paper to come in contact with polyvinyl chloride film, erasers, or adhesive tape for long periods of time. ・ Keep the paper away from freshly copied diazo type or wet process copy paper. 1. 2. 3. Paper cover open button Paper cutter Paper cover ■ Loading the printer paper ■ 11.. Press the paper cover open button. The paper cover will open. 22.. Insert the paper as shown in the diagram at right. Position the paper such that the leading edge extends outside the printer, and press both sides of the paper cover to close it. Note The printer will be turned on and off simultaneously with the equipment. 10-5 Options Operation 10.4 Printer (NKG-800) CAUTION The print head of the NKG-800 printer may be very hot after printing. Do not touch the print head of the printer. Make sure that the print head is cool before replacing the paper or cleaning the print head. Do not use the NKG-800 printer if there is no ink ribbon cartridge or paper. Do not twist the ink ribbon when installing the ink ribbon cartridge. Before opening and closing the cover of the NKG-800 printer, turn off the printer. Wait more than 2 seconds after turning the printer off before turning it back on again so it can initialize correctly. Roll support cover Prevents printed roll paper from being wound back in. Roll paper Roll paper cover Roll paper stand Roll bar Passes through the printing roll paper. Roll paper cutter Paper feed knob Printer cover Print head Contacts the roll paper for printing. Operation panel Friction lever When replacing the roll paper, pull this lever towards the front before inserting the paper, and return it towards the back after paper is inserted. Power switch Platen Paper is fed in contact with this platen when the friction lever is pushed towards the back. The following shows the functions of the operation panel. P.PARK Paper Park Rewinds the roll paper. FF Feed Form Feeds paper one page at a time. LF Line Feed Feeds the paper one line at a time. NLQ High-quality Printing Switches the printer to the high-quality printing mode. ONLINE Printer Ready Setting The printer is ready for printing when the lamp is lit. Note 1: Before performing P.PARK/FF/LF/NLQ, press ONLINE to set the printer offline (lamp out). Note 2: When the printer runs out of roll paper, the P.OUT lamp lights and the printer automatically goes offline. 10-6 Options Operation ■ Loading the printer paper ■ 11.. Turn the printer OFF, loosen the roll paper stand fixing screws, and slide the stand backwards to open the printer cover. At this step, also remove the roll paper cover. Fixing screws 22.. Pass the roll bar through the roll paper, and install the roll paper onto the roll paper stand paying attention to its orientation. Roll bar Roll paper 33.. Pass the roll paper over the guide bar as shown in the figure at right. Guide bar 44.. Pull the friction lever towards the front, and insert the leading edge of the paper into the rear of the platen. Then, return the friction lever to the back, and turn the paper feed knob to feed the paper out. Platen 55.. Lift the paper load lever up to hold down paper fed out of the platen. Paper load lever 10-7 Options Operation 66.. Return the roll paper cover to its original position, and place the roll support cover as shown in the figure at right. Roll support cover Roll paper cover 77.. Close the printer cover, return the roll paper stand to its original position, and tighten the fixing screws. Note To perform a print test, turn the printer on with the LF key held down. To end the print test, turn the printer off. ■ Replacing the ink ribbon ■ 11.. Turn the printer on, and following the same procedure as that in the previous section, open the printer cover, lift up the ink ribbon cartridge by holding the projection on the cartridge, and lift the cartridge up to remove it. Projection Ink ribbon cartridge 22.. Using the knob on the new cartridge to make the ribbon taut, manually move the print head to the left edge, and attach the ribbon so that it is between the ribbon mask and print head. Print head Knob Ink ribbon cartridge 33.. Close the printer cover, return the roll paper stand to its original position, and tighten the fixing screws. Note 10-8 For other details, check the NKG-800 Installation Guide. The printer's operation mode can be set by the DIP switches. However, leave the DIP switch settings at their factory defaults (all off) when using the printer connected to the equipment. Options Operation 10.5 Operations using a SELCALL unit The JSS-2250/2500 MF/HF radio equipment can be connected to external selective calling devices for fishing boats (Selcall) to send signals for calling Selcall buoys or Selcall receivers on ships. Note For details on operations of the Selcall device, refer to the manuals of that device. ■ Procedure ■ 11.. Finish all menu operations to return the screen to the status display. When a transmission is made from the Selcall device while menus are displayed, menus can no longer be operated until transmission ends. ID 431001234 23:59(UTC) Pos 89゚59.0123'N 179゚59.6789'E@23:59 (EXT) TEL ITU- 401 RX 4357.0 kHz TX 4065.0 kHz SIG NonDST: WKR scan bands: DR O B O S : 2 4 6 8 12 16MHz Ed t D S T : 22.. Set the communication mode to TEL and the assigned frequency (e.g. 2331.5 kHz) for transmitting on the Selcall device in the free frequency input mode. Then tune the antenna by pressing TAUNNTE key. In this case, input both the Rx and Tx frequencies as simplex frequencies. 33.. Operate the Selcall device to start transmission. When transmission is started, the communications mode automatically changes to H2B as shown at right. 44.. When transmission ends, the communications mode returns to the original mode. 10-9 Options Operation 10-10 Appendix 11. Appendix This section lists frequencies used for DSC such as frequencies used for routine calls and frequencies used for safety and distress calls. It also lists the channel list of ITU frequencies built-in to this equipment and the instructions for operating the MF/HF radio equipment. 11.1 Frequencies for distress and safety calls The following is a list of international transmission frequencies (all simplex) used by coast and ship stations for distress and safety purposes either with DSC, radiotelephone or telex. CH No. indicates channel numbers preprogrammed to this equipment. ( DSC) TRx( kHz) 2187.5 CH No. --- 401 4207.5 601 6312.0 801 TRx( kHz) ( telex) CH No. --- TRx( kHz) 2182.0 --- 4125.0 411 4177.5 --- 6215.0 611 6268.0 8414.5 833 8291.0 801 8376.5 1201 12577.0 --- 12290.0 1287 12520.0 1601 16804.5 --- 16420.0 1624 16695.0 Note ( radiotelephone) CH No. --- 2174.5 When making DSC calls, the frequencies above can only be used if the message category is Distress, Urgency, or Safety. The DSC frequencies listed above are watched by the DSC watch keeping receiver. The radiotelephone frequencies other than 8291.0 kHz are the same as the transmission frequencies of ITU channels 421, 606, 1221 and 1621. However, when making calls for distress and safety purposes, use these frequencies as simplex channels. RR Appendix 15 RR Article 52.221.3 11-1 Appendix 11.2 National DSC frequencies for routine calls When ship and coast stations call national stations for purposes that are not safety or distress purposes, normally use the national frequencies allocated by the administrator prior to using the international frequencies listed later. The frequencies for Japan are as follows. Additionally, the pair frequencies are used to make a call to the coast station. Tx (kHz) 4180.5 6275.5 Rx (kHz) 2169.0 4218.0 6326.5 Tx (kHz) 8391.5 12521.0 16721.0 Rx (kHz) 8431.5 12623.0 16844.0 Tx (kHz) 18872.0 22318.0 25175.0 Rx (kHz) 19682.5 22410.0 26103.0 11.3 International DSC frequencies for routine calls The following international frequencies are used when calling ship and coast stations via DSC if the other station's nationality or the frequency they are watching is not know, except for safety or distress calls. CH No. indicates channel numbers preprogrammed to this equipment. CH No. --- Note Tx (kHz) 2189.5 Rx (kHz) 2177.0 1602 16805.0 16903.0 402 4208.0 4219.5 1603 16805.5 16903.5 403 4208.5 4220.0 1604 16806.0 16904.0 404 4209.0 4220.5 1801 18898.5 19703.5 602 6312.5 6331.0 1802 18899.0 19704.0 603 6313.0 6331.5 1803 18899.5 19704.5 604 6313.5 6332.0 2201 22374.5 22444.0 Tx (kHz) Rx (kHz) 802 8415.0 8436.5 2202 22375.0 22444.5 803 8415.5 8437.0 2203 22375.5 22445.0 804 8416.0 8437.5 2501 25208.5 26121.0 1202 12577.5 12657.0 2502 25209.0 26121.5 1203 12578.0 12657.5 2503 25209.5 26122.0 1204 12578.5 12658.0 The above frequencies can only be used when the DSC message category is Routine. The above table lists the sending and receiving frequencies (duplex) when a ship station calls a coast station. Normally routine calls between ship stations use 2177.0 kHz (simplex) as first choice frequency. Channels not listed in the table above (401/601/801/1201/1601) are the frequencies listed earlier for distress and safety purposes. In the table above, channels 402/602/802/1202/1602/1801/2201/2501 should be selected first when making routine DSC calls on international frequencies. ITU-R M.541-9 Annex 3 4.1.2 RR Appendix 15 RR Appendix 17 part A footnote l 11-2 CH No. Appendix 11.4 ITU channel list (TEL/CW/TLX) This section lists the channels preprogrammed into this equipment as TEL, CW and TLX ITU frequencies. (1) Radiotelephone mode (ITU-RR Appendix 17) CH No. Tx (kHz) Rx (kHz) 401 4065.0 402 Remarks CH No. Tx (kHz) Rx (kHz) 4357.0 607 6218.0 6519.0 4068.0 4360.0 608 6221.0 6522.0 403 4071.0 4363.0 609 6224.0 6224.0 Simplex (*3) 404 4074.0 4366.0 610 6227.0 6227.0 Simplex (*3) 405 4077.0 4369.0 611 6230.0 6230.0 Simplex (*3) 406 4080.0 4372.0 407 4083.0 4375.0 801 8195.0 8719.0 408 4086.0 4378.0 802 8198.0 8722.0 409 4089.0 4381.0 803 8201.0 8725.0 410 4092.0 4384.0 804 8204.0 8728.0 411 4095.0 4387.0 805 8207.0 8731.0 412 4098.0 4390.0 806 8210.0 8734.0 413 4101.0 4393.0 807 8213.0 8737.0 414 4104.0 4396.0 808 8216.0 8740.0 415 4107.0 4399.0 809 8219.0 8743.0 416 4110.0 4402.0 810 8222.0 8746.0 417 4113.0 4405.0 811 8225.0 8749.0 418 4116.0 4408.0 812 8228.0 8752.0 419 4119.0 4411.0 813 8231.0 8755.0 420 4122.0 4414.0 814 8234.0 8758.0 815 8237.0 8761.0 (*1)(*2) 421 4125.0 4417.0 422 4128.0 4420.0 816 8240.0 8764.0 423 4131.0 4423.0 817 8243.0 8767.0 424 4134.0 4426.0 818 8246.0 8770.0 425 4137.0 4429.0 819 8249.0 8773.0 426 4140.0 4432.0 820 8252.0 8776.0 427 4143.0 4435.0 821 8255.0 8779.0 428 4146.0 4146.0 429 4149.0 4149.0 Simplex (*4) 822 8258.0 8782.0 Simplex (*5) 823 8261.0 8785.0 824 8264.0 8788.0 601 6200.0 6501.0 825 8267.0 8791.0 602 6203.0 6504.0 826 8270.0 8794.0 603 6206.0 6507.0 827 8273.0 8797.0 604 6209.0 6510.0 828 8276.0 8800.0 605 6212.0 6513.0 829 8279.0 8803.0 830 8282.0 8806.0 606 6215.0 6516.0 (*1)(*2) Remarks (*2) 11-3 Appendix CH No. Tx (kHz) Rx (kHz) 831 8285.0 8809.0 832 8288.0 8812.0 Remarks CH No. Tx (kHz) Rx (kHz) 1239 12344.0 13191.0 1240 12347.0 13194.0 1241 12350.0 13197.0 Remarks 833 8291.0 8291.0 Simplex (*1) 834 8294.0 8294.0 Simplex (*6) 1242 12353.0 12353.0 Simplex (*3) 835 8297.0 8297.0 Simplex (*7) 1243 12356.0 12356.0 Simplex (*3) 1244 12359.0 12359.0 Simplex (*2) 1201 12230.0 13077.0 1245 12362.0 12362.0 Simplex (*3) 1202 12233.0 13080.0 1246 12365.0 12365.0 Simplex (*3) 1203 12236.0 13083.0 1204 12239.0 13086.0 1601 16360.0 17242.0 1205 12242.0 13089.0 1602 16363.0 17245.0 1206 12245.0 13092.0 1603 16366.0 17248.0 1207 12248.0 13095.0 1604 16369.0 17251.0 1208 12251.0 13098.0 1605 16372.0 17254.0 1209 12254.0 13101.0 1606 16375.0 17257.0 1210 12257.0 13104.0 1607 16378.0 17260.0 1211 12260.0 13107.0 1608 16381.0 17263.0 1212 12263.0 13110.0 1609 16384.0 17266.0 1213 12266.0 13113.0 1610 16387.0 17269.0 1214 12269.0 13116.0 1611 16390.0 17272.0 1215 12272.0 13119.0 1612 16393.0 17275.0 1216 12275.0 13122.0 1613 16396.0 17278.0 1217 12278.0 13125.0 1614 16399.0 17281.0 1218 12281.0 13128.0 1615 16402.0 17284.0 1219 12284.0 13131.0 1616 16405.0 17287.0 1220 12287.0 13134.0 1617 16408.0 17290.0 1618 16411.0 17293.0 (*1) (*8) 1221 12290.0 13137.0 1222 12293.0 13140.0 1619 16414.0 17296.0 1223 12296.0 13143.0 1620 16417.0 17299.0 1224 12299.0 13146.0 1621 16420.0 17302.0 1225 12302.0 13149.0 1622 16423.0 17305.0 1226 12305.0 13152.0 1623 16426.0 17308.0 1227 12308.0 13155.0 1624 16429.0 17311.0 1228 12311.0 13158.0 1625 16432.0 17314.0 1229 12314.0 13161.0 1626 16435.0 17317.0 1230 12317.0 13164.0 1627 16438.0 17320.0 1231 12320.0 13167.0 1628 16441.0 17323.0 1232 12323.0 13170.0 1629 16444.0 17326.0 1233 12326.0 13173.0 1630 16447.0 17329.0 1234 12329.0 13176.0 1631 16450.0 17332.0 1235 12332.0 13179.0 1632 16453.0 17335.0 1236 12335.0 13182.0 1633 16456.0 17338.0 1237 12338.0 13185.0 1634 16459.0 17341.0 1238 12341.0 13188.0 1635 16462.0 17344.0 11-4 (*1) (*9) Appendix CH No. Tx (kHz) Rx (kHz) 1636 16465.0 1637 CH No. Tx (kHz) Rx (kHz) Remarks 17347.0 1816 18825.0 18825.0 Simplex (*3) 16468.0 17350.0 1817 18828.0 18828.0 Simplex (*3) 1638 16471.0 17353.0 1818 18831.0 18831.0 Simplex (*3) 1639 16474.0 17356.0 1819 18834.0 18834.0 Simplex (*3) 1640 16477.0 17359.0 1820 18837.0 18837.0 Simplex (*3) 1641 16480.0 17362.0 1821 18840.0 18840.0 Simplex (*3) 1642 16483.0 17365.0 1822 18843.0 18843.0 Simplex (*3) 1643 16486.0 17368.0 1644 16489.0 17371.0 2201 22000.0 22696.0 1645 16492.0 17374.0 2202 22003.0 22699.0 1646 16495.0 17377.0 2203 22006.0 22702.0 1647 16498.0 17380.0 2204 22009.0 22705.0 1648 16501.0 17383.0 2205 22012.0 22708.0 1649 16504.0 17386.0 2206 22015.0 22711.0 1650 16507.0 17389.0 2207 22018.0 22714.0 1651 16510.0 17392.0 2208 22021.0 22717.0 1652 16513.0 17395.0 2209 22024.0 22720.0 1653 16516.0 17398.0 2210 22027.0 22723.0 1654 16519.0 17401.0 2211 22030.0 22726.0 1655 16522.0 17404.0 2212 22033.0 22729.0 1656 16525.0 17407.0 1657 1658 1659 1660 1661 1662 1663 16528.0 16531.0 16534.0 16537.0 16540.0 16543.0 16546.0 16528.0 16531.0 16534.0 16537.0 16540.0 16543.0 16546.0 Remarks 2213 22036.0 22732.0 Simplex (*3) 2214 22039.0 22735.0 Simplex (*3) 2215 22042.0 22738.0 Simplex (*3) 2216 22045.0 22741.0 Simplex (*2) 2217 22048.0 22744.0 Simplex (*3) 2218 22051.0 22747.0 Simplex (*3) 2219 22054.0 22750.0 Simplex (*3) 2220 22057.0 22753.0 2221 22060.0 22756.0 1801 18780.0 19755.0 2222 22063.0 22759.0 1802 18783.0 19758.0 2223 22066.0 22762.0 1803 18786.0 19761.0 2224 22069.0 22765.0 1804 18789.0 19764.0 2225 22072.0 22768.0 1805 18792.0 19767.0 2226 22075.0 22771.0 2227 22078.0 22774.0 (*2) 1806 18795.0 19770.0 1807 18798.0 19773.0 2228 22081.0 22777.0 1808 18801.0 19776.0 2229 22084.0 22780.0 1809 18804.0 19779.0 2230 22087.0 22783.0 1810 18807.0 19782.0 2231 22090.0 22786.0 1811 18810.0 19785.0 2232 22093.0 22789.0 1812 18813.0 19788.0 2233 22096.0 22792.0 1813 18816.0 19791.0 2234 22099.0 22795.0 1814 18819.0 19794.0 2235 22102.0 22798.0 1815 18822.0 19797.0 2236 22105.0 22801.0 (*2) 11-5 Appendix CH No. Tx (kHz) Rx (kHz) 2237 22108.0 2238 Remarks CH No. Tx (kHz) Rx (kHz) Remarks 22804.0 2258 22171.0 22171.0 Simplex (*3) 22111.0 22807.0 2259 22174.0 22174.0 Simplex (*3) 2239 22114.0 22810.0 2260 22177.0 22177.0 Simplex (*3) 2240 22117.0 22813.0 2241 22120.0 22816.0 2501 25070.0 26145.0 2242 22123.0 22819.0 2502 25073.0 26148.0 2243 22126.0 22822.0 2503 25076.0 26151.0 2244 22129.0 22825.0 2504 25079.0 26154.0 2245 22132.0 22828.0 2505 25082.0 26157.0 2246 22135.0 22831.0 2506 25085.0 26160.0 2247 22138.0 22834.0 2507 25088.0 26163.0 2248 22141.0 22837.0 2508 25091.0 26166.0 2249 22144.0 22840.0 2509 25094.0 26169.0 2250 22147.0 22843.0 2510 25097.0 26172.0 (*2) 2251 22150.0 22846.0 2511 25100.0 25100.0 Simplex (*3) 2252 22153.0 22849.0 2512 25103.0 25103.0 Simplex (*3) 2253 22156.0 22852.0 2513 25106.0 25106.0 Simplex (*3) 2254 22159.0 22159.0 Simplex (*3) 2514 25109.0 25109.0 Simplex (*3) 2255 22162.0 22162.0 Simplex (*3) 2515 25112.0 25112.0 Simplex (*3) 2256 22165.0 22165.0 Simplex (*3) 2516 25115.0 25115.0 Simplex (*3) 2257 22168.0 22168.0 Simplex (*3) 2517 25118.0 25118.0 Simplex (*3) *1) Used for distress and safety purposes (operates duplex channel as simplex). *2) For calling. *3) For inter-ship communications. *4) For inter-ship communications. You can also communicate with coast stations on Rx 4351.0 kHz. *5) For inter-ship communications. You can also communicate with coast stations on Rx 4354.0 kHz. *6) For inter-ship communications. You can also communicate with coast stations on Rx 8707.0 kHz. *7) For inter-ship communications. You can also communicate with coast stations on Rx 8710.0 kHz. *8) From January 2004, calling on channel 1221 is prohibited. *9) From January 2004, calling on channel 1621 is prohibited. 11-6 Appendix (2) Additional usable frequencies in TEL mode (ITU-RR Appendix 17 / Sub Section C-1/ C-2) Tx (kHz) Rx (kHz) Remarks Tx (kHz) Rx (kHz) Remarks 4000.0 4000.0 Simplex 8116.0 81160. Simplex 4003.0 4003.0 Simplex 8119.0 8119.0 Simplex 4006.0 4006.0 Simplex 8122.0 8122.0 Simplex 4009.0 4009.0 Simplex 8125.0 8125.0 Simplex 4012.0 4012.0 Simplex 8128.0 8128.0 Simplex 4015.0 4015.0 Simplex 8131.0 8131.0 Simplex 4018.0 4018.0 Simplex 8134.0 8134.0 Simplex 4021.0 4021.0 Simplex 8137.0 8137.0 Simplex 4024.0 4024.0 Simplex 8140.0 8140.0 Simplex 4027.0 4027.0 Simplex 8143.0 8143.0 Simplex 4030.0 4030.0 Simplex 8146.0 8146.0 Simplex 4033.0 4033.0 Simplex 8149.0 8149.0 Simplex 4036.0 4036.0 Simplex 8152.0 8152.0 Simplex 4039.0 4039.0 Simplex 8155.0 8155.0 Simplex 4042.0 4042.0 Simplex 8158.0 8158.0 Simplex 4045.0 4045.0 Simplex 8161.0 8161.0 Simplex 4048.0 4048.0 Simplex 8164.0 8164.0 Simplex 4051.0 4051.0 Simplex 8167.0 8167.0 Simplex 4054.0 4054.0 Simplex 8170.0 8170.0 Simplex 4057.0 4057.0 Simplex 8173.0 8173.0 Simplex 4060.0 4060.0 Simplex 8176.0 8176.0 Simplex 8179.0 8179.0 Simplex 8101.0 8101.0 Simplex 8182.0 8182.0 Simplex 8104.0 8104.0 Simplex 8185.0 8185.0 Simplex 8107.0 8107.0 Simplex 8188.0 8188.0 Simplex 8110.0 8110.0 Simplex 8191.0 8191.0 Simplex 8113.0 8113.0 Simplex 11-7 Appendix (3) CW mode (ITU-RR Appendix 17) CH No. TRx (kHz) Remarks CH No. TRx (kHz) Remarks CH No. TRx (kHz) Remarks 401 4182.0 Calling 605 6278.0 Calling 809 8370.0 Calling 402 4182.5 Calling 606 6278.5 Calling 810 8370.5 Calling 403 4184.0 Calling 607 6279.0 Calling 811 8342.0 404 4184.5 Calling 608 6279.5 Calling 812 8342.5 405 4183.0 Calling 609 6280.0 Calling 813 8343.0 406 4183.5 Calling 610 6280.5 Calling 814 8343.5 407 4185.0 Calling 611 6285.0 815 8344.0 408 4185.5 Calling 612 6285.5 816 8344.5 409 4186.0 Calling 613 6286.0 817 8345.0 410 4186.5 614 6286.5 818 8345.5 411 4187.0 615 6287.0 819 8346.0 412 4187.5 616 6287.5 820 8346.5 413 4188.0 617 6288.0 821 8347.0 414 4188.5 618 6288.5 822 8347.5 415 4189.0 619 6289.0 823 8348.0 416 4189.5 620 6289.5 824 8348.5 417 4190.0 621 6290.0 825 8349.0 418 4190.5 622 6290.5 826 8349.5 419 4191.0 623 6291.0 827 8350.0 420 4191.5 624 6291.5 828 8350.5 421 4192.0 625 6292.0 829 8351.0 422 4192.5 626 6292.5 830 8351.5 423 4193.0 627 6293.0 831 8352.0 424 4193.5 628 6293.5 832 8352.5 425 4194.0 629 6294.0 833 8353.0 426 4194.5 630 6294.5 834 8353.5 427 4195.0 631 6295.0 835 8354.0 428 4195.5 632 6295.5 836 8354.5 429 4196.0 633 6296.0 837 8355.0 430 4196.5 634 6296.5 838 8355.5 431 4197.0 635 6297.0 839 8356.0 432 4197.5 636 6297.5 840 8356.5 433 4198.0 637 6298.0 841 8357.0 434 4198.5 638 6298.5 842 8357.5 435 4199.0 639 6299.0 843 8358.0 436 4199.5 640 6299.5 844 8358.5 437 4200.0 641 6300.0 845 8359.0 438 4200.5 846 8359.5 439 4201.0 801 8366.0 Calling 847 8360.0 440 4201.5 802 8366.5 Calling 848 8360.5 441 4202.0 803 8368.0 Calling 849 8361.0 804 8369.0 Calling 850 8361.5 601 6277.0 Calling 805 8367.0 Calling 851 8362.0 602 6277.5 Calling 806 8367.5 Calling 852 8362.5 603 6276.0 Calling 807 8368.5 Calling 853 8363.0 604 6276.5 Calling 808 8369.5 Calling 854 8363.5 11-8 Appendix CH No. TRx (kHz) Remarks CH No. TRx (kHz) Remarks CH No. TRx (kHz) Remarks 855 8364.0 1232 12432.5 1279 12456.0 856 8364.5 1233 12433.0 1280 12456.5 857 8365.0 1234 12433.5 1281 12457.0 858 8365.5 1235 12434.0 1282 12457.5 859 8371.0 1236 12434.5 1283 12458.0 860 8371.5 1237 12435.0 1284 12458.5 861 8372.0 1238 12435.5 1285 12459.0 862 8372.5 1239 12436.0 1286 12459.5 863 8373.0 1240 12436.5 1287 12460.0 864 8373.5 1241 12437.0 1288 12460.5 865 8374.0 1242 12437.5 1289 12461.0 866 8374.5 1243 12438.0 1290 12461.5 867 8375.0 1244 12438.5 1291 12462.0 868 8375.5 1245 12439.0 1292 12462.5 869 8376.0 1246 12439.5 1293 12463.0 1247 12440.0 1294 12463.5 1201 12550.0 Calling 1248 12440.5 1295 12464.0 1202 12550.5 Calling 1249 12441.0 1296 12464.5 1203 12552.0 Calling 1250 12441.5 1297 12465.0 1204 12553.5 Calling 1251 12442.0 1298 12465.5 1205 12551.0 Calling 1252 12442.5 1299 12466.0 1206 12551.5 Calling 1253 12443.0 12100 12466.5 1207 12552.5 Calling 1254 12443.5 12101 12467.0 1208 12553.0 Calling 1255 12444.0 12102 12467.5 1209 12554.0 Calling 1256 12444.5 12103 12468.0 1210 12554.5 Calling 1257 12445.0 12104 12468.5 1211 12422.0 1258 12445.5 12105 12469.0 1212 12422.5 1259 12446.0 12106 12469.5 1213 12423.0 1260 12446.5 12107 12470.0 1214 12423.5 1261 12447.0 12108 12470.5 1215 12424.0 1262 12447.5 12109 12471.0 1216 12424.5 1263 12448.0 12110 12471.5 1217 12425.0 1264 12448.5 12111 12472.0 1218 12425.5 1265 12449.0 12112 12472.5 1219 12426.0 1266 12449.5 12113 12473.0 1220 12426.5 1267 12450.0 12114 12473.5 1221 12427.0 1268 12450.5 12115 12474.0 1222 12427.5 1269 12451.0 12116 12474.5 1223 12428.0 1270 12451.5 12117 12475.0 1224 12428.5 1271 12452.0 12118 12475.5 1225 12429.0 1272 12452.5 12119 12476.0 1226 12429.5 1273 12453.0 12120 12476.5 1227 12430.0 1274 12453.5 1228 12430.5 1275 12454.0 1601 16734.0 Calling 1229 12431.0 1276 12454.5 1602 16734.5 Calling 1230 12431.5 1277 12455.0 1603 16736.0 Calling 1231 12432.0 1278 12455.5 1604 16738.0 Calling 11-9 Appendix CH No. TRx (kHz) Remarks CH No. TRx (kHz) Remarks CH No. TRx (kHz) Remarks 1605 16735.0 Calling 1652 16639.5 1699 16663.0 1606 16735.5 Calling 1653 16640.0 16100 16663.5 1607 16736.5 Calling 1654 16640.5 16101 16664.0 1608 16737.0 Calling 1655 16641.0 16102 16664.5 1609 16737.5 Calling 1656 16641.5 16103 16665.0 1610 16738.5 Calling 1657 16642.0 16104 16665.5 1611 16619.0 1658 16642.5 16105 16666.0 1612 16619.5 1659 16643.0 16106 16666.5 1613 16620.0 1660 16643.5 16107 16667.0 1614 16620.5 1661 16644.0 16108 16667.5 1615 16621.0 1662 16644.5 16109 16668.0 1616 16621.5 1663 16645.0 16110 16668.5 1617 16622.0 1664 16645.5 16111 16669.0 1618 16622.5 1665 16646.0 16112 16669.5 1619 16623.0 1666 16646.5 16113 16670.0 1620 16623.5 1667 16647.0 16114 16670.5 1621 16624.0 1668 16647.5 16115 16671.0 1622 16624.5 1669 16648.0 16116 16671.5 1623 16625.0 1670 16648.5 16117 16672.0 1624 16625.5 1671 16649.0 16118 16672.5 1625 16626.0 1672 16649.5 16119 16673.0 1626 16626.5 1673 16650.0 16120 16673.5 1627 16627.0 1674 16650.5 16121 16674.0 1628 16627.5 1675 16651.0 16122 16674.5 1629 16628.0 1676 16651.5 16123 16675.0 1630 16628.5 1677 16652.0 16124 16675.5 1631 16629.0 1678 16652.5 16125 16676.0 1632 16629.5 1679 16653.0 16126 16676.5 1633 16630.0 1680 16653.5 16127 16677.0 1634 16630.5 1681 16654.0 16128 16677.5 1635 16631.0 1682 16654.5 16129 16678.0 1636 16631.5 1683 16655.0 16130 16678.5 1637 16632.0 1684 16655.5 16131 16679.0 1638 16632.5 1685 16656.0 16132 16679.5 1639 16633.0 1686 16656.5 16133 16680.0 1640 16633.5 1687 16657.0 16134 16680.5 1641 16634.0 1688 16657.5 16135 16681.0 1642 16634.5 1689 16658.0 16136 16681.5 1643 16635.0 1690 16658.5 16137 16682.0 1644 16635.5 1691 16659.0 16138 16682.5 1645 16636.0 1692 16659.5 16139 16683.0 1646 16636.5 1693 16660.0 1647 16637.0 1694 16660.5 2201 22279.5 Calling 1648 16637.5 1695 16661.0 2202 22280.0 Calling 1649 16638.0 1696 16661.5 2203 22280.5 Calling 1650 16638.5 1697 16662.0 2204 22281.0 Calling 1651 16639.0 1698 16662.5 2205 22281.5 Calling 11-10 Appendix CH No. TRx (kHz) Remarks CH No. TRx (kHz) Remarks CH No. TRx (kHz) Remarks 2206 22282.0 Calling 2241 22257.0 2276 22274.5 2207 22282.5 Calling 2242 22257.5 2277 22275.0 2208 22283.0 Calling 2243 22258.0 2278 22275.5 2209 22283.5 Calling 2244 22258.5 2279 22276.0 2210 22284.0 Calling 2245 22259.0 2280 22276.5 2211 22242.0 2246 22259.5 2281 22277.0 2212 22242.5 2247 22260.0 2282 22277.5 2213 22243.0 2248 22260.5 2283 22278.0 2214 22243.5 2249 22261.0 2284 22278.5 2215 22244.0 2250 22261.5 2285 22279.0 2216 22244.5 2251 22262.0 2217 22245.0 2252 22262.5 2501 25171.5 Calling 2218 22245.5 2253 22263.0 2502 25172.0 Calling 2219 22246.0 2254 22263.5 2503 25171.5 Calling 2220 22246.5 2255 22264.0 2504 25172.5 Calling 2221 22247.0 2256 22264.5 2505 25161.5 2222 22247.5 2257 22265.0 2506 25162.0 2223 22248.0 2258 22265.5 2507 25162.5 2224 22248.5 2259 22266.0 2508 25163.0 2225 22249.0 2260 22266.5 2509 25163.5 2226 22249.5 2261 22267.0 2510 25164.0 2227 22250.0 2262 22267.5 2511 25164.5 2228 22250.5 2263 22268.0 2512 25165.0 2229 22251.0 2264 22268.5 2513 25165.5 2230 22251.5 2265 22269.0 2514 25166.0 2231 22252.0 2266 22269.5 2515 25166.5 2232 22252.5 2267 22270.0 2516 25167.0 2233 22253.0 2268 22270.5 2517 25167.5 2234 22253.5 2269 22271.0 2518 25168.0 2235 22254.0 2270 22271.5 2519 25168.5 2236 22254.5 2271 22272.0 2520 25169.0 2237 22255.0 2272 22272.5 2521 25169.5 2238 22255.5 2273 22273.0 2522 25170.0 2239 22256.0 2274 22273.5 2523 25170.5 2240 22256.5 2275 22274.0 2524 25171.0 11-11 Appendix (4) Telex mode( ITU-RR Appendix 17) CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks 401 4172.5 4210.5 614 6269.5 6320.5 402 4173.0 4211.0 615 6270.0 6321.0 403 4173.5 4211.5 616 6270.5 6321.5 404 4174.0 4212.0 617 6271.0 6322.0 405 4174.5 4212.5 618 6271.5 6322.5 406 4175.0 4213.0 619 6272.0 6323.0 407 4175.5 4213.5 620 6272.5 6323.5 408 4176.0 4214.0 621 6273.0 6324.0 409 4176.5 4214.5 622 6273.5 6324.5 410 4177.0 4215.0 623 6274.0 6325.0 624 6274.5 6325.5 Simplex (*1) 411 4177.5 4177.5 412 4178.0 4215.5 625 6275.0 6326.0 413 4178.5 4216.0 626 6275.5 6326.5 414 4179.0 4216.5 627 6281.0 6327.0 415 4179.5 4217.0 628 6281.5 6327.5 416 4180.0 4217.5 629 6282.0 6328.0 417 4180.5 4218.0 630 6282.5 6328.5 418 4181.0 4218.5 631 6283.0 6329.0 419 4181.5 4219.0 632 6283.5 6329.5 420 4202.5 4202.5 Simplex 633 6284.0 6330.0 421 4203.0 4203.0 Simplex 634 6284.5 6330.5 422 4203.5 4203.5 Simplex 635 6300.5 6300.5 Simplex 423 4204.0 4204.0 Simplex 636 6301.0 6301.0 Simplex 424 4204.5 4204.5 Simplex 637 6301.5 6301.5 Simplex 425 4205.0 4205.0 Simplex 638 6302.0 6302.0 Simplex 426 4205.5 4205.5 Simplex 639 6302.5 6302.5 Simplex 427 4206.0 4206.0 Simplex 640 6303.0 6303.0 Simplex 428 4206.5 4206.5 Simplex 641 6303.5 6303.5 Simplex 429 4207.0 4207.0 Simplex 642 6304.0 6304.0 Simplex 643 6304.5 6304.5 Simplex 601 6263.0 6314.5 644 6305.0 6305.0 Simplex 602 6263.5 6315.0 645 6305.5 6305.5 Simplex 603 6264.0 6315.5 646 6306.0 6306.0 Simplex 604 6264.5 6316.0 647 6306.5 6306.5 Simplex 605 6265.0 6316.5 648 6307.0 6307.0 Simplex 606 6265.5 6317.0 649 6307.5 6307.5 Simplex 607 6266.0 6317.5 650 6308.0 6308.0 Simplex 608 6266.5 6318.0 651 6308.5 6308.5 Simplex 609 6267.0 6318.5 652 6309.0 6309.0 Simplex 610 6267.5 6319.0 653 6309.5 6309.5 Simplex 654 6310.0 6310.0 Simplex 611 6268.0 6268.0 612 6268.5 6319.5 655 6310.5 6310.5 Simplex 613 6269.0 6320.0 656 6311.0 6311.0 Simplex 11-12 Simplex (*1) Appendix CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks 657 6311.5 843 8397.5 8397.5 Simplex 844 8398.0 8398.0 Simplex 845 8398.5 8398.5 Simplex 6311.5 Simplex Simplex (*1) 801 8376.5 8376.5 802 8377.0 8417.0 846 8399.0 8399.0 Simplex 803 8377.5 8417.5 847 8399.5 8399.5 Simplex 804 8378.0 8418.0 848 8400.0 8400.0 Simplex 805 8378.5 8418.5 849 8400.5 8400.5 Simplex 806 8379.0 8419.0 850 8401.0 8401.0 Simplex 807 8379.5 8419.5 851 8401.5 8401.5 Simplex 808 8380.0 8420.0 852 8402.0 8402.0 Simplex 809 8380.5 8420.5 853 8402.5 8402.5 Simplex 810 8381.0 8421.0 854 8403.0 8403.0 Simplex 811 8381.5 8421.5 855 8403.5 8403.5 Simplex 812 8382.0 8422.0 856 8404.0 8404.0 Simplex 813 8382.5 8422.5 857 8404.5 8404.5 Simplex 814 8383.0 8423.0 858 8405.0 8405.0 Simplex 815 8383.5 8423.5 859 8405.5 8405.5 Simplex 816 8384.0 8424.0 860 8406.0 8406.0 Simplex 817 8384.5 8424.5 861 8406.5 8406.5 Simplex 818 8385.0 8425.0 862 8407.0 8407.0 Simplex 819 8385.5 8425.5 863 8407.5 8407.5 Simplex 820 8386.0 8426.0 864 8408.0 8408.0 Simplex 821 8386.5 8426.5 865 8408.5 8408.5 Simplex 822 8387.0 8427.0 866 8409.0 8409.0 Simplex 823 8387.5 8427.5 867 8409.5 8409.5 Simplex 824 8388.0 8428.0 868 8410.0 8410.0 Simplex 825 8388.5 8428.5 869 8410.5 8410.5 Simplex 826 8389.0 8429.0 870 8411.0 8411.0 Simplex 827 8389.5 8429.5 871 8411.5 8411.5 Simplex 828 8390.0 8430.0 872 8412.0 8412.0 Simplex 829 8390.5 8430.5 873 8412.5 8412.5 Simplex 830 8391.0 8431.0 874 8413.0 8413.0 Simplex 831 8391.5 8431.5 875 8413.5 8413.5 Simplex 832 8392.0 8432.0 876 8414.0 8414.0 Simplex 833 8392.5 8432.5 834 8393.0 8433.0 1201 12477.0 12579.5 835 8393.5 8433.5 1202 12477.5 12580.0 836 8394.0 8434.0 1203 12478.0 12580.5 837 8394.5 8434.5 1204 12478.5 12581.0 838 8395.0 8435.0 1205 12479.0 12581.5 839 8395.5 8435.5 1206 12479.5 12582.0 840 8396.0 8436.0 1207 12480.0 12582.5 841 8396.5 8396.5 Simplex 1208 12480.5 12583.0 842 8397.0 8397.0 Simplex 1209 12481.0 12583.5 11-13 Appendix CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks 1210 12481.5 12584.0 1254 12503.5 12606.0 1211 12482.0 12584.5 1255 12504.0 12606.5 1212 12482.5 12585.0 1256 12504.5 12607.0 1213 12483.0 12585.5 1257 12505.0 12607.5 1214 12483.5 12586.0 1258 12505.5 12608.0 1215 12484.0 12586.5 1259 12506.0 12608.5 1216 12484.5 12587.0 1260 12506.5 12609.0 1217 12485.0 12587.5 1261 12507.0 12609.5 1218 12485.5 12588.0 1262 12507.5 12610.0 1219 12486.0 12588.5 1263 12508.0 12610.5 1220 12486.5 12589.0 1264 12508.5 12611.0 1221 12487.0 12589.5 1265 12509.0 12611.5 1222 12487.5 12590.0 1266 12509.5 12612.0 1223 12488.0 12590.5 1267 12510.0 12612.5 1224 12488.5 12591.0 1268 12510.5 12613.0 1225 12489.0 12591.5 1269 12511.0 12613.5 1226 12489.5 12592.0 1270 12511.5 12614.0 1227 12490.0 12592.5 1271 12512.0 12614.5 1228 12490.5 12593.0 1272 12512.5 12615.0 1229 12491.0 12593.5 1273 12513.0 12615.5 1230 12491.5 12594.0 1274 12513.5 12616.0 1231 12492.0 12594.5 1275 12514.0 12616.5 1232 12492.5 12595.0 1276 12514.5 12617.0 1233 12493.0 12595.5 1277 12515.0 12617.5 1234 12493.5 12596.0 1278 12515.5 12618.0 1235 12494.0 12596.5 1279 12516.0 12618.5 1236 12494.5 12597.0 1280 12516.5 12619.0 1237 12495.0 12597.5 1281 12517.0 12619.5 1238 12495.5 12598.0 1282 12517.5 12620.0 1239 12496.0 12598.5 1283 12518.0 12620.5 1240 12496.5 12599.0 1284 12518.5 12621.0 1241 12497.0 12599.5 1285 12519.0 12621.5 1242 12497.5 12600.0 1286 12519.5 12622.0 1243 12498.0 12600.5 1287 12520.0 12520.0 1244 12498.5 12601.0 1288 12520.5 12622.5 1245 12499.0 12601.5 1289 12521.0 12623.0 1246 12499.5 12602.0 1290 12521.5 12623.5 1247 12500.0 12602.5 1291 12522.0 12624.0 1248 12500.5 12603.0 1292 12522.5 12624.5 1249 12501.0 12603.5 1293 12523.0 12625.0 1250 12501.5 12604.0 1294 12523.5 12625.5 1251 12502.0 12604.5 1295 12524.0 12626.0 1252 12502.5 12605.0 1296 12524.5 12626.5 1253 12503.0 12605.5 1297 12525.0 12627.0 11-14 Simplex (*1) Appendix CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks 1298 12525.5 12627.5 12142 12547.5 12649.5 1299 12526.0 12628.0 12143 12548.0 12650.0 12100 12526.5 12628.5 12144 12548.5 12650.5 12101 12527.0 12629.0 12145 12549.0 12651.0 12102 12527.5 12629.5 12146 12549.5 12651.5 12103 12528.0 12630.0 12147 12555.0 12652.0 12104 12528.5 12630.5 12148 12555.5 12652.5 12105 12529.0 12631.0 12149 12556.0 12653.0 12106 12529.5 12631.5 12150 12556.5 12653.5 12107 12530.0 12632.0 12151 12557.0 12654.0 12108 12530.5 12632.5 12152 12557.5 12654.5 12109 12531.0 12633.0 12153 12558.0 12655.0 12110 12531.5 12633.5 12154 12558.5 12655.5 12111 12532.0 12634.0 12155 12559.0 12656.0 12112 12532.5 12634.5 12156 12559.5 12656.5 12113 12533.0 12635.0 12157 12560.0 12560.0 Simplex 12114 12533.5 12635.5 12158 12560.5 12560.5 Simplex 12115 12534.0 12636.0 12159 12561.0 12561.0 Simplex 12116 12534.5 12636.5 12160 21561.5 12561.5 Simplex 12117 12535.0 12637.0 12161 12562.0 12562.0 Simplex 12118 12535.5 12637.5 12162 12562.5 12562.5 Simplex 12119 12536.0 12638.0 12163 12563.0 12563.0 Simplex 12120 12536.5 12638.5 12164 12563.5 12563.5 Simplex 12121 12537.0 12639.0 12165 12564.0 12564.0 Simplex 12122 12537.5 12639.5 12166 12564.5 12564.5 Simplex 12123 12538.0 12640.0 12167 12565.0 12565.0 Simplex 12124 12538.5 12640.5 12168 12565.5 12565.5 Simplex 12125 12539.0 12641.0 12169 12566.0 12566.0 Simplex 12126 12539.5 12641.5 12170 12566.5 12566.5 Simplex 12127 12540.0 12642.0 12171 12567.0 12567.0 Simplex 12128 12540.5 12642.5 12172 12567.5 12567.5 Simplex 12129 21541.0 12643.0 12173 12568.0 12568.0 Simplex 12130 12541.5 12643.5 12174 12568.5 12568.5 Simplex 12131 12542.0 12644.0 12175 12569.0 12569.0 Simplex 12132 12542.5 12644.5 12176 12569.5 12569.5 Simplex 12133 12543.0 12645.0 12177 12570.0 12570.0 Simplex 12134 12543.5 12645.5 12178 12570.5 12570.5 Simplex 12135 12544.0 12646.0 12179 12571.0 12571.0 Simplex 12136 12544.5 12646.5 12180 12571.5 12571.5 Simplex 12137 12545.0 12647.0 12181 12572.0 12572.0 Simplex 12138 12545.5 12647.5 12182 12572.5 12572.5 Simplex 12139 12546.0 12648.0 12183 12573.0 12573.0 Simplex 12140 12546.5 12648.5 12184 12573.5 12573.5 Simplex 12141 12547.0 12649.0 12185 12574.0 12574.0 Simplex 11-15 Appendix CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks 12186 12574.5 12574.5 Simplex 1639 16702.5 16825.5 12187 12575.0 12575.0 Simplex 1640 16703.0 16826.0 12188 12575.5 12575.5 Simplex 1641 16703.5 16826.5 12189 12576.0 12576.0 Simplex 1642 16704.0 16827.0 12190 12576.5 12576.5 Simplex 1643 16704.5 16827.5 1644 16705.0 16828.0 1601 16683.5 16807.0 1645 16705.5 16828.5 1602 16684.0 16807.5 1646 16706.0 16829.0 1603 16684.5 16808.0 1647 16706.5 16829.5 1604 16685.0 16808.5 1648 16707.0 16830.0 1605 16685.5 16809.0 1649 16707.5 16830.5 1606 16686.0 16809.5 1650 16708.0 16831.0 1607 16686.5 16810.0 1651 16708.5 16831.5 1608 16687.0 16810.5 1652 16709.0 16832.0 1609 16687.5 16811.0 1653 16709.5 16832.5 1610 16688.0 16811.5 1654 16710.0 16833.0 1611 16688.5 16812.0 1655 16710.5 16833.5 1612 16689.0 16812.5 1656 16711.0 16834.0 1613 16689.5 16813.0 1657 16711.5 16834.5 1614 16690.0 16813.5 1658 16712.0 16835.0 1615 16690.5 16814.0 1659 16712.5 16835.5 1616 16691.0 16814.5 1660 16713.0 16836.0 1617 16691.5 16815.0 1661 16713.5 16836.5 1618 16692.0 16815.5 1662 16714.0 16837.0 1619 16692.5 16816.0 1663 16714.5 16837.5 1620 16693.0 16816.5 1664 16715.0 16838.0 1621 16693.5 16817.0 1665 16715.5 16838.5 1622 16694.0 16817.5 1666 16716.0 16839.0 1623 16694.5 16818.0 1667 16716.5 16839.5 1624 16695.0 16695.0 1668 16717.0 16840.0 1625 16695.5 16818.5 1669 16717.5 16840.5 1626 16696.0 16819.0 1670 16718.0 16841.0 1627 16696.5 16819.5 1671 16718.5 16841.5 1628 16697.0 16820.0 1672 16719.0 16842.0 1629 16697.5 16820.5 1673 16719.5 16842.5 1630 16698.0 16821.0 1674 16720.0 16843.0 1631 16698.5 16821.5 1675 16720.5 16843.5 1632 16699.0 16822.0 1676 16721.0 16844.0 1633 16699.5 16822.5 1677 16721.5 16844.5 1634 16700.0 16823.0 1678 16722.0 16845.0 1635 16700.5 16823.5 1679 16722.5 16845.5 1636 16701.0 16824.0 1680 16723.0 16846.0 1637 16701.5 16824.5 1681 16723.5 16846.5 1638 16702.0 16825.0 1682 16724.0 16847.0 11-16 Simplex (*1) Appendix CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks 1683 16724.5 16847.5 16127 16751.5 16869.5 1684 16725.0 16848.0 16128 16752.0 16870.0 1685 16725.5 16848.5 16129 16752.5 16870.5 1686 16726.0 16849.0 16130 16753.0 16871.0 1687 16726.5 16849.5 16131 16753.5 16871.5 1688 16727.0 16850.0 16132 16754.0 16872.0 1689 16727.5 16850.5 16133 16754.5 16872.5 1690 16728.0 16851.0 16134 16755.0 16873.0 1691 16728.5 16851.5 16135 16755.5 16873.5 1692 16729.0 16852.0 16136 16756.0 16874.0 1693 16729.5 16852.5 16137 16756.5 16874.5 1694 16730.0 16853.0 16138 16757.0 16875.0 1695 16730.5 16853.5 16139 16757.5 16875.5 1696 16731.0 16854.0 16140 16758.0 16876.0 1697 16731.5 16854.5 16141 16758.5 16876.5 1698 16732.0 16855.0 16142 16759.0 16877.0 1699 16732.5 16855.5 16143 16759.5 16877.5 16100 16733.0 16856.0 16144 16760.0 16878.0 16101 16733.5 16856.5 16145 16760.5 16878.5 16102 16739.0 16857.0 16146 16761.0 16879.0 16103 16739.5 16857.5 16147 16761.5 16879.5 16104 16740.0 16858.0 16148 16762.0 16880.0 16105 16740.5 16858.5 16149 16762.5 16880.5 16106 16741.0 16859.0 16150 16763.0 16881.0 16107 16741.5 16859.5 16151 16763.5 16881.5 16108 16742.0 16860.0 16152 16764.0 16882.0 16109 16742.5 16860.5 16153 16764.5 16882.5 16110 16743.0 16861.0 16154 16765.0 16883.0 16111 16743.5 16861.5 16155 16765.5 16883.5 16112 16744.0 16862.0 16156 16766.0 16884.0 16113 16744.5 16862.5 16157 16766.5 16884.5 16114 16745.0 16863.0 16158 16767.0 16885.0 16115 16745.5 16863.5 16159 16767.5 16885.5 16116 16746.0 16864.0 16160 16768.0 16886.0 16117 16746.5 16864.5 16161 16768.5 16886.5 16118 16747.0 16865.0 16162 16769.0 16887.0 16119 16747.5 16865.5 16163 16769.5 16887.5 16120 16748.0 16866.0 16164 16770.0 16888.0 16121 16748.5 16866.5 16165 16770.5 16888.5 16122 16749.0 16867.0 16166 16771.0 16889.0 16123 16749.5 16867.5 16167 16771.5 16889.5 16124 16750.0 16868.0 16168 16772.0 16890.0 16125 16750.5 16868.5 16169 16772.5 16890.5 16126 16751.0 16869.0 16170 16773.0 16891.0 11-17 Appendix CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks 16171 16773.5 16891.5 16215 16795.5 16795.5 Simplex 16172 16774.0 16892.0 16216 16796.0 16796.0 Simplex 16173 16774.5 16892.5 16217 16796.5 16796.5 Simplex 16174 16775.0 16893.0 16218 16797.0 16797.0 Simplex 16175 16775.5 16893.5 16219 16797.5 16797.5 Simplex 16176 16776.0 16894.0 16220 16798.0 16798.0 Simplex 16177 16776.5 16894.5 16221 16798.5 16798.5 Simplex 16178 16777.0 16895.0 16222 16799.0 16799.0 Simplex 16179 16777.5 16895.5 16223 16799.5 16799.5 Simplex 16180 16778.0 16896.0 16224 16800.0 16800.0 Simplex 16181 16778.5 16896.5 16225 16800.5 16800.5 Simplex 16182 16779.0 16897.0 16226 16801.0 16801.0 Simplex 16183 16779.5 16897.5 16227 16801.5 16801.5 Simplex 16184 16780.0 16898.0 16228 16802.0 16802.0 Simplex 16185 16780.5 16898.5 16229 16802.5 16802.5 Simplex 16186 16781.0 16899.0 16230 16803.0 16803.0 Simplex 16187 16781.5 16899.5 16231 16803.5 16803.5 Simplex 16188 16782.0 16900.0 16232 16804.0 16804.0 Simplex 16189 16782.5 16900.5 16190 16783.0 16901.0 1801 18870.5 19681.0 16191 16783.5 16901.5 1802 18871.0 19681.5 16192 16784.0 16902.0 1803 18871.5 19682.0 16193 16784.5 16902.5 1804 18872.0 19682.5 16194 16785.0 16785.0 Simplex 1805 18872.5 19683.0 16195 16785.5 16785.5 Simplex 1806 18873.0 19683.5 16196 16786.0 16786.0 Simplex 1807 18873.5 19684.0 16197 16786.5 16786.5 Simplex 1808 18874.0 19684.5 16198 16787.0 16787.0 Simplex 1809 18874.5 19685.0 16199 16787.5 16787.5 Simplex 1810 18875.0 19685.5 16200 16788.0 16788.0 Simplex 1811 18875.5 19686.0 16201 16788.5 16788.5 Simplex 1812 18876.0 19686.5 16202 16789.0 16789.0 Simplex 1813 18876.5 19687.0 16203 16789.5 16789.5 Simplex 1814 18877.0 19687.5 16204 16790.0 16790.0 Simplex 1815 18877.5 19688.0 16205 16790.5 16790.5 Simplex 1816 18878.0 19688.5 16206 16791.0 16791.0 Simplex 1817 18878.5 19689.0 16207 16791.5 16791.5 Simplex 1818 18879.0 19689.5 16208 16792.0 16792.0 Simplex 1819 18879.5 19690.0 16209 16792.5 16792.5 Simplex 1820 18880.0 19690.5 16210 16793.0 16793.0 Simplex 1821 18880.5 19691.0 16211 16793.5 16793.5 Simplex 1822 18881.0 19691.5 16212 16794.0 16794.0 Simplex 1823 18881.5 19692.0 16213 16794.5 16794.5 Simplex 1824 18882.0 19692.5 16214 16795.0 16795.0 Simplex 1825 18882.5 19693.0 11-18 Appendix CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks 1826 18883.0 19693.5 2213 22290.5 22382.5 1827 18883.5 19694.0 2214 22291.0 22383.0 1828 18884.0 19694.5 2215 22291.5 22383.5 1829 18884.5 19695.0 2216 22292.0 22384.0 1830 18885.0 19695.5 2217 22292.5 22384.5 1831 18885.5 19696.0 2218 22293.0 22385.0 1832 18886.0 19696.5 2219 22293.5 22385.5 1833 18886.5 19697.0 2220 22294.0 22386.0 1834 18887.0 19697.5 2221 22294.5 22386.5 1835 18887.5 19698.0 2222 22295.0 22387.0 1836 18888.0 19698.5 2223 22295.5 22387.5 1837 18888.5 19699.0 2224 22296.0 22388.0 1838 18889.0 19699.5 2225 22296.5 22388.5 1839 18889.5 19700.0 2226 22297.0 22389.0 1840 18890.0 19700.5 2227 22297.5 22389.5 1841 18890.5 19701.0 2228 22298.0 22390.0 1842 18891.0 19701.5 2229 22298.5 22390.5 1843 18891.5 19702.0 2230 22299.0 22391.0 1844 18892.0 19702.5 2231 22299.5 22391.5 1845 18892.5 19703.0 2232 22300.0 22392.0 1846 18893.0 18893.0 Simplex 2233 22300.5 22392.5 1847 18893.5 18893.5 Simplex 2234 22301.0 22393.0 1848 18894.0 18894.0 Simplex 2235 22301.5 22393.5 1849 18894.5 18894.5 Simplex 2236 22302.0 22394.0 1850 18895.0 18895.0 Simplex 2237 22302.5 22394.5 1851 18895.5 18895.5 Simplex 2238 22303.0 22395.0 1852 18896.0 18896.0 Simplex 2239 22303.5 22395.5 1853 18896.5 18896.5 Simplex 2240 22304.0 22396.0 1854 18897.0 18897.0 Simplex 2241 22304.5 22396.5 1855 18897.5 18897.5 Simplex 2242 22305.0 22397.0 1856 18898.0 18898.0 Simplex 2243 22305.5 22397.5 2244 22306.0 22398.0 2201 22284.5 22376.5 2245 22306.5 22398.5 2202 22285.0 22377.0 2246 22307.0 22399.0 2203 22285.5 22377.5 2247 22307.5 22399.5 2204 22286.0 22378.0 2248 22308.0 22400.0 2205 22286.5 22378.5 2249 22308.5 22400.5 2206 22287.0 22379.0 2250 22309.0 22401.0 2207 22287.5 22379.5 2251 22309.5 22401.5 2208 22288.0 22380.0 2252 22310.0 22402.0 2209 22288.5 22380.5 2253 22310.5 22402.5 2210 22289.0 22381.0 2254 22311.0 22403.0 2211 22289.5 22381.5 2255 22311.5 22403.5 2212 22290.0 22382.0 2256 22312.0 22404.0 11-19 Appendix CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks 2257 22312.5 22404.5 22101 22334.5 22426.5 2258 22313.0 22405.0 22102 22335.0 22427.0 2259 22313.5 22405.5 22103 22335.5 22427.5 2260 22314.0 22406.0 22104 22336.0 22428.0 2261 22314.5 22406.5 22105 22336.5 22428.5 2262 22315.0 22407.0 22106 22337.0 22429.0 2263 22315.5 22407.5 22107 22337.5 22429.5 2264 22316.0 22408.0 22108 22338.0 22430.0 2265 22316.5 22408.5 22109 22338.5 22430.5 2266 22317.0 22409.0 22110 22339.0 22431.0 2267 22317.5 22409.5 22111 22339.5 22431.5 2268 22318.0 22410.0 22112 22340.0 22432.0 2269 22318.5 22410.5 22113 22340.5 22432.5 2270 22319.0 22411.0 22114 22341.0 22433.0 2271 22319.5 22411.5 22115 22341.5 22433.5 2272 22320.0 22412.0 22116 22342.0 22434.0 2273 22320.5 22412.5 22117 22342.5 22434.5 2274 22321.0 22413.0 22118 22343.0 22435.0 2275 22321.5 22413.5 22119 22343.5 22435.5 2276 22322.0 22414.0 22120 22344.0 22436.0 2277 22322.5 22414.5 22121 22344.5 22436.5 2278 22323.0 22415.0 22122 22345.0 22437.0 2279 22323.5 22415.5 22123 22345.5 22437.5 2280 22324.0 22416.0 22124 22346.0 22438.0 2281 22324.5 22416.5 22125 22346.5 22438.5 2282 22325.0 22417.0 22126 22347.0 22439.0 2283 22325.5 22417.5 22127 22347.5 22439.5 2284 22326.0 22418.0 22128 22348.0 22440.0 2285 22326.5 22418.5 22129 22348.5 22440.5 2286 22327.0 22419.0 22130 22349.0 22441.0 2287 22327.5 22419.5 22131 22349.5 22441.5 2288 22328.0 22420.0 22132 22350.0 22442.0 2289 22328.5 22420.5 22133 22350.5 22442.5 2290 22329.0 22421.0 22134 22351.0 22443.0 2291 22329.5 22421.5 22135 22351.5 22443.5 2292 22330.0 22422.0 22136 22352.0 22352.0 Simplex 2293 22330.5 22422.5 22137 22352.5 22352.5 Simplex 2294 22331.0 22423.0 22138 22353.0 22353.0 Simplex 2295 22331.5 22423.5 22139 22353.5 22353.5 Simplex 2296 22332.0 22424.0 22140 22354.0 22354.0 Simplex 2297 22332.5 22424.5 22141 22354.5 22354.5 Simplex 2298 22333.0 22425.0 22142 22355.0 22355.0 Simplex 2299 22333.5 22425.5 22143 22355.5 22355.5 Simplex 22100 22334.0 22426.0 22144 22356.0 22356.0 Simplex 11-20 Appendix CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks 22145 22356.5 22356.5 Simplex 2508 25176.5 26104.5 22146 22357.0 22357.0 Simplex 2509 25177.0 26105.0 22147 22357.5 22357.5 Simplex 2510 25177.5 26105.5 22148 22358.0 22358.0 Simplex 2511 25178.0 26106.0 22149 22358.5 22358.5 Simplex 2512 25178.5 26106.5 22150 22359.0 22359.0 Simplex 2513 25179.0 26107.0 22151 22359.5 22359.5 Simplex 2514 25179.5 26107.5 22152 22360.0 22360.0 Simplex 2515 25180.0 26108.0 22153 22360.5 22360.5 Simplex 2516 25180.5 26108.5 22154 22361.0 22361.0 Simplex 2517 25181.0 26109.0 22155 22361.5 22361.5 Simplex 2518 25181.5 26109.5 22156 22362.0 22362.0 Simplex 2519 25182.0 26110.0 22157 22362.5 22362.5 Simplex 2520 25182.5 26110.5 22158 22363.0 22363.0 Simplex 2521 25183.0 26111.0 22159 22363.5 22363.5 Simplex 2522 25183.5 26111.5 22160 22364.0 22364.0 Simplex 2523 25184.0 26112.0 22161 22364.5 22364.5 Simplex 2524 25184.5 26112.5 22162 22365.0 22365.0 Simplex 2525 25185.0 26113.0 22163 22365.5 22365.5 Simplex 2526 25185.5 26113.5 22164 22366.0 22366.0 Simplex 2527 25186.0 26114.0 22165 22366.5 22366.5 Simplex 2528 25186.5 26114.5 22166 22367.0 22367.0 Simplex 2529 25187.0 26115.0 22167 22367.5 22367.5 Simplex 2530 25187.5 26115.5 22168 22368.0 22368.0 Simplex 2531 25188.0 26116.0 22169 22368.5 22368.5 Simplex 2532 25188.5 26116.5 22170 22369.0 22369.0 Simplex 2533 25189.0 26117.0 22171 22369.5 22369.5 Simplex 2534 25189.5 26117.5 22172 22370.0 22370.0 Simplex 2535 25190.0 26118.0 22173 22370.5 22370.5 Simplex 2536 25190.5 26118.5 22174 22371.0 22371.0 Simplex 2537 25191.0 26119.0 22175 22371.5 22371.5 Simplex 2538 25191.5 26119.5 22176 22372.0 22372.0 Simplex 2539 25192.0 26120.0 22177 22372.5 22372.5 Simplex 2540 25192.5 26120.5 22178 22373.0 22373.0 Simplex 2541 25193.0 25193.0 Simplex 22179 22373.5 22373.5 Simplex 2542 25193.5 25193.5 Simplex 22180 22374.0 22374.0 Simplex 2543 25194.0 25194.0 Simplex 2544 25194.5 25194.5 Simplex 2501 25173.0 26101.0 2545 25195.0 25195.0 Simplex 2502 25173.5 26101.5 2546 25195.5 25195.5 Simplex 2503 25174.0 26102.0 2547 25196.0 25196.0 Simplex 2504 25174.5 26102.5 2548 25196.5 25196.5 Simplex 2505 25175.0 26103.0 2549 25197.0 25197.0 Simplex 2506 25175.5 26103.5 2550 25197.5 25197.5 Simplex 2507 25176.0 26104.0 2551 25198.0 25198.0 Simplex 11-21 Appendix CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks CH No. Tx( kHz) Rx( kHz) Remarks 2552 25198.5 25198.5 Simplex 2562 25203.5 25203.5 Simplex 2553 25199.0 25199.0 Simplex 2563 25204.0 25204.0 Simplex 2554 25199.5 25199.5 Simplex 2564 25204.5 25204.5 Simplex 2555 25200.0 25200.0 Simplex 2565 25205.0 25205.0 Simplex 2556 25200.5 25200.5 Simplex 2566 25205.5 25205.5 Simplex 2557 25201.0 25201.0 Simplex 2567 25206.0 25206.0 Simplex 2558 25201.5 25201.5 Simplex 2568 25206.5 25206.5 Simplex 2559 25202.0 25202.0 Simplex 2569 25207.0 25207.0 Simplex 2560 25202.5 25202.5 Simplex 2570 25207.5 25207.5 Simplex 2561 25203.0 25203.0 Simplex 2571 25208.0 25208.0 Simplex *1) Used for distress and safety purposes. 11-22 Appendix 11.5 Guide to MF/HF operation Be aware of the following points when using the MF/HF radio equipment. z Frequencies available for communication are always changing. z Not all frequency bandwidths can always be used for communication. z After sending the DSC test call to a coast station, you will not always receive the acknowledgement. 1. About the MF/HF radio equipment Although for ship MF/HF radio equipment the 1.6 MHz to 27.5 MHz frequencies are normally available, select an appropriate frequency from the frequencies assigned to your ship for communication. As noted below, the use of the appropriate frequency depends upon the radio wave propagation characteristics of the ionosphere. Therefore, not all frequency bands are available for communication even if the equipment is functioning properly. 2. Special characteristics of MF/HF radio wave propagation As shown in the figure to the right, the Ionosphere F1/F2 layer F 1/F2層 major MF/HF radio waves used for 電離層 communications are terrestrial waves E層 Ionosphere layer (path 1) and waves reflected from the 電 離層 ionosphere (paths 2 and 3). You can 層 Ionosphere DDlayer communicate using waves reflected from 電離層 the ionosphere and the earth because the effective communication range of Station Station 無線局 B 無線局 A terrestrial waves is limited 6 . The available range of frequencies for Earth 地表 communication depends upon the radio wave propagation characteristics of the ionosphere. They will also change dramatically depending on the position and distance from the station, the season, the time, and the sunspot number (approx. 0 to 250) which changes every 11 years 7 . 3. Selecting communication frequencies MF/HF band communication frequencies cannot be predetermined. However, you can select frequencies referring to previous communications logs, the frequency transition table in this chapter under "Selecting communication frequencies in the MF/HF band (reference)", and the radio wave propagation image. 4. About DSC testing DSC operation is prescribed as an international standard 8 of the ITU and coast stations that receive DSC test calls should acknowledge the calls. Responses may be sent manually instead of automatically depending on the equipment at the coast station. It may take longer than expected to receive the acknowledgement even if your equipment is functioning properly and you have selected the proper frequency. You may experience skip zones where both terrestrial waves and waves reflected from the ionosphere are unavailable at the end of the effective communication range of terrestrial waves. Radio wave propagation is affected by phasing, the Dellinger phenomenon, magnetic storms, and atmospherics. Interference tends to be greater at night when radio waves can travel greater distances. ITU-R Recommendation M. 541 11-23 Appendix Selecting communication frequencies in the MF/HF band (reference) When communicating with the MF/HF radio equipment, select frequencies referring to the frequency transition table and the radio wave propagation images (excluding the polar latitudes) shown below 9 . Example: ¾ When communicating with a station approximately 5000 km away at around 12 pm in the winter with a sunspot number of 100, select frequencies in the 18, 22, or 25 MHz bands for the best results. Frequency transition table 通信条件 Transmissions conditions 距離 Distance 遠距離 Long distances (e.g. 5000 km) (例:5000km) 季節と時刻 Season & time 冬 Winter 夏 Summer Winter 冬 Short distances 近距離 (例:1000km) (e.g. 1000 km) ¾ Summer 夏 Guideline for selecting frequency (for a sunspot count of 100) 周波数選択の目安 (太陽の黒点数 = 100の場合) 2M 4M 6M 8M 12M 16M 18M 22M 日中 Day 夜間 Night 日中 Day 夜間 Night Day 日中 Night 夜間 Day 日中 Night 夜間 Radio wave propagation images These are based on the prediction of HF radio wave propagations. Communication is not guaranteed. 11-24 25M 7ZPJD0604 电子信息产品有害物资申明 日本无线株式会社 Declaration on toxic & hazardous substances or elements of Electronic Information Products Japan Radio Company Limited 有毒有害物质或元素的名称及含量 (Names & Content of toxic and hazardous substances or elements) 形式名(Type): JSS-2250/2500 JSS 2250/2500 名称(Name): MF/HF Radio equipment 有毒有害物质或元素 (Toxic and Hazardous Substances and Elements) 部件名称 (Part name) 天线 ((Antenna)) 船内装置 (Inboard Unit) 外部设备(Peripherals) ・选择(Options) ・打印机(Printer) ・电线类(Cables) ・手册(Documennts) 铅 汞 镉 六价铬 多溴联苯 多溴二苯醚 (Pb) (Hg) (Cd) (Cr6+) (PBB) (PBDE) × ○ × × × × × ○ × × × × × ○ × × × × ○:表示该有毒有害物质在该部件所有均质材料中的含量均在SJ/T11306-2006 标准规定的限量要求以下。 (Indicates that this toxic, or hazardous substance contained in all of the homogeneous materials for this part is below the requirement in SJ/T11363-2006.) ×:表示该有毒有害物质至少在该部件的某一均质材料中的含量超出SJ/T11363-2006 标准规定的限量要求。 (Indicates that this toxic or hazardous substance contained in at least one of the homogeneous materials used for this part is above the limit requirement in SJ/T 11363-2006.) RE: 中华人民共和国电子信息产品污染控制管理办法 Management Methods on Control of Pollution from Electronics Information Products of the People's Republic of China -1/1- Marking with market circulation mark According to the requirements of clause 20 of Technical Regulations about safety of Maritime transport objetcs, approved by Resolution of the Russian Federation Goverment #620 dated August 12, 2010 and requirements Technical Regulation of the Russian Federation Goverment #623 dated August 12, 2010 navigation & radiotelephone equipment should be marked by company – manufacturer with market-circulation mark the way it is determined by Legislation of the Russia federation on technical regulation. According to the airticle 27 PZ No184 –FZ of Federal Law about Technical Regulation dated December 12, 2002 and Resolution of the Russian Federation Goverment dated 19.11.03 No0696 navigation equipment has an appropriate marking. The marking can be perfomed by one of four variants, depending on surface colour of equipment. The images should be grey scale and should contrast against the surface colour (ref. to the Resolution of the Russian Federation Goverment No696 < > dated November 19, 2003). The marking of Radio and navigational equipment should be done by the manufacturer (supplier) according to the clause 2 of the article 27 of the Federal Law No.184 –FZ << About technical Regulation>> and should be applied right to device surface. - 1/1 -
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf PDF Version : 1.6 Linearized : Yes XMP Toolkit : 3.1-701 Modify Date : 2013:07:17 20:27:04+09:00 Create Date : 2013:07:16 12:06:51+09:00 Metadata Date : 2013:07:17 20:27:04+09:00 Creator Tool : PScript5.dll Version 5.2 Format : application/pdf Title : Microsoft Word - JSS-2250n2500AP取説E_0.doc Creator : j08088 Document ID : uuid:3d18ec5e-8f4f-42a2-981d-2497a4a00998 Instance ID : uuid:7b3a91be-6085-4909-a330-064f871cdce4 Producer : Acrobat Distiller 7.0 (Windows) Page Count : 196 Author : j08088EXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools